The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in The Changed World
The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in The Changed World
The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in The Changed World
PROCEEDINGS
EBEEC 2015
http://ebeec.teikav.edu.gr
organized by
ISBN: 978-960-363-063-0
ISSN: 1792-4383
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Contents
FAST-FOOD SERVICE QUALITY AND CUSTOMER SATISFACTION: AN
EMPIRICAL STUDY IN GREECE ....................................................................................... 1
KATARACHIA ANDRONIKI KONSTANTINIDIS ANASTASIOS.................................................... 1
IRRATIONAL BEHAVIOR AND MENTAL ACCOUNTING ........................................ 10
ANASTASIOS KONSTANTINIDIS, ANDRONIKI KATARACHIA................................................. 10
TO LAUGH OR TO CRY WHEN A COMPETITOR DIES? FAILURE OF THE
FOURTH BIGGEST BANK IN BULGARIA ..................................................................... 16
BOJIDAR ARCHINKOV ........................................................................................................... 16
PROMOTION POLICIES MICROFINANCE GROWTH AND DEVELOPMENT OF
AGRICULTURE IN ALBANIA (CASE ALBANIAN SAVINGS AND CREDIT UNION)
.................................................................................................................................................. 25
ALMA DELIJA AND STEFAN QIRICI ................................................................................... 25
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE IN THE BLACK SEA REGION: TRENDS AND
DEVELOPMENTS................................................................................................................. 35
ANTONIADIS IOANNIS, SORMAS ASTERIOS AND ALEXANDRIDIS ANASTASIOS ................... 35
A NEW TYPE OF GOODS: ECUMENICAL OR UNIVERSAL GOODS ...................... 45
DEMOSTHENES GEORGOPOULOS, THEODORE PAPADOGONAS AND GEORGE SFAKIANAKIS
.............................................................................................................................................. 45
THE CONTRIBUTION OF THE SOCIAL CAPITAL IN MANAGING THE EFFECTS
OF THE ECONOMIC CRISIS IN THE URBAN AND RURAL AREAS OF EASTERN
THESSALY ............................................................................................................................. 54
THEODOSSIOU GEORGE, ZISIS APOSTOLOS AND THANOU ELENI ........................................ 54
TIME DRIVEN ACTIVITY BASED COSTING APPLIED IN HELLENIC POST
OFFICE ................................................................................................................................... 64
KARTALIS NIKOLAOS AND MATIS KONSTANTINOS.............................................................. 64
GREEK PEOPLE’S ATTITUDES TOWARD BOUNDARYLESS MINDSET
CAREERS ............................................................................................................................... 75
BATIOU VASILIKI, ANASTASIADOU SOFIA ........................................................................... 75
LEGAL AND REGULATORY ISSUES OF FINANCIAL SECURITIES IN ALBANIA
EDLIRA LUÇI ......................................................................................................................... 81
AUDITING PROCEDURES APPLIES IN AN SA FOR CONTROL OF VAT,
WITHHOLDING TAX AND PROPERTY TAXATION ................................................... 86
MICHAILIDOU SVETLANA AND AGELOS ZOITSAS ................................................................ 86
RISK ASSESSMENT IN CROSS-BORDER ACQUISITIONS IN CENTRAL AND
EASTERN EUROPEAN MARKETS ................................................................................... 91
ALEN SACEK ......................................................................................................................... 91
CUSTOMER SATISFACTION DEVELOPMENT IN RETAIL BUSINESS ............... 99
DAGMAR LESAKOVA ............................................................................................................ 99
-iii-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
SUBSIDIZED CROP INSURANCE IN POLAND – ANALYSIS OF 10 YEARS OF
FUNCTIONING ................................................................................................................... 106
MARIETTA JANOWICZ-LOMOTT AND KRZYSZTOF LYSKAWA ........................................... 106
THE SYSTEM DESIGN AND IMPLEMENTATION OF REQUEST DEVELOPMENT
SYSTEM ON THE FOCUS OF DECISION SUPPORT SYSTEM
TOLGA UREKLI YILMAZ GÖKSEN ONUR DOGAN AND HAKAN ASAN ................................ 115
“GREEN PRODUCT”: WHERE WE ARE AND WERE TO GO? ............................... 121
SDROLIA EVANGELIA AND ZAROTIADIS GRIGORIS .......................................................... 121
INFORMALITY OR CORRUPTION? THE CASE OF UKRAINIAN FIRMS ........... 127
YAROSLAV PRYTULA AND ELENA DENISOVA-SCHMIDT ................................................... 127
EXAMINING THE E-GAMBLERS’ BEHAVIOR: AN EMPIRICAL STUDY ............ 136
VAGGELIS SAPRIKIS AND ANDRONIKI KATARACHIA ......................................................... 136
POLITICAL RISKS AND THEIR IMPACT ON WESTERN COMPANIES IN RUSSIA
................................................................................................................................................ 149
EWA MARTYNA-DAVID ...................................................................................................... 149
PREFERENCE OF EDUCATION: UNIVERSAL SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT
CONTEXT ............................................................................................................................ 159
EGLE CELIESIENE AND GIEDRE KVIESKIENE .................................................................... 159
INDEX ................................................................................................................................... 167
-iv-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Fast food franchise restaurants have had a considerable growth as people’s eating habits have been affected by
modern lifestyles and new consumer patterns. The present study explores customers’ perceptions of the Greek
fast food restaurant service quality and its relationship to customer satisfaction considering specific dimensions of
satisfaction and a number of demographic information. In order to achieve the research objective, a questionnaire
on customer satisfaction was distributed and answered by 220 fast-food customers. The r e s e a r c h findings
indicate that quality of food and service are the most important factors influencing satisfaction, whereas pricing
policy proved to be a quite problematic factor in assessing customer satisfaction. Managerial implications, study
limitations and directions for future research are also discussed.
KEYWORDS
Consumer behaviour, Customer satisfaction, Fast food, Customer services quality
1. INTRODUCTION
Modern lifestyles, by establishing the model of "quick service", have affected our eating habits and
tastes, and have, therefore, made fast food consumption a major consumer food alternative. Nowadays,
the fast food industry, also known as Quick Service Restaurants, takes up one of the largest segments
of the food industry worldwide. Despite the considerable growth of enterprises-chains-fast food
restaurants through innovative marketing strategies, customer satisfaction in fast food restaurants has
not been thoroughly researched, in view of the undergoing differentiations in terms of a series of
demographic, spatial and cultural features in the respective customer base.
Research has identified various factors, both customer- and situational-specific, which affect overall
customer satisfaction (Zeithmal and Binter, 2000). In Greece, fast food consumption, despite the recent
socio-economic crisis, which has changed consumers’ lifestyles, had a rapid increase in the last
decades. According to a Nielsen survey, 88% of the people in Greece have considerably reduced the
frequency of going out, compared with other Europeans, and, owing to incomes shrink, they do not opt
for dining out (Charondakis, 2012). The specific food service industry, with a total annual turnover of
2.1 billion, is rated as one of the most significant industries in the Greek market. 27% is controlled by
organized chains - Goody's, Everest, McDonald's, Gregory, KFC, Roma Pizza, Venice, Pizza Hut, Pie
Pan etc. - whereas the remaining 73% includes thousands of small businesses. It is worth noting,
however, that since 2011 the decrease in consumer disposable income, resulting from the economic
recession and, subsequently, VAT increase from 8% to 23% have had an adverse effect on restaurant
turnovers (www.iefimerida.gr,2013) .
Nowadays, fast food operations of both organized chains and the thousands of small enterprises are
encountered with a fierce competition from food specialist retailers and other foodservice channels,
which gained ground against fast food by expanding the number of outlets and/or by extending their
menus and dropping their prices. Manrai & Manrai (2007) indicate that customer satisfaction, related to
the desire to change providers and overall consumer behavior, underscores the ability of an
organization to compete effectively in the contemporary environment of global economy. The hard
economic circumstances and the fiercely competitive environment in Greece have forced fast food
-1-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
restaurants to accommodate to new trends and pressures. Re-examining mainly aspects of quality, taste,
price, and, overall, the unique experience for customers, fast food chains, in order to retain and possibly
increase the number of customers, are rather called to redesign the marketing mix of products and
services.
The present research is based on data drawn from “Goody’s” customers’ views about their
satisfaction with a number of factors. It is worth noting that “Goody's”, a domestic burger fast food
chain for 40 years, with 167 outlets in Greece, has been the leader in chained fast food and the most
popular amongst Greeks. The main objective of the research is to explore customers' perceptions of the
Greek fast food restaurant service quality and its relationship to customer satisfaction considering
specific dimensions of satisfaction and a number of demographic information. In an increasingly
competitive and especially forced environment, the research attempts to identify the components of fast
food quality that affect customer satisfaction, and provide vital information to enable managers to
identify the "whats" and "hows" of service-quality improvement and, thus, re-establish their
competitive advantage.
The research is organised as follows: first, it includes an outline of the extant literature concerning
quality and satisfaction, with particular emphasis on the relationship of quality and satisfaction in the
fast food industry. Next, it provides a discussion of the research methodology as well as the empirical
research results. Finally, it concludes by identifying study limitations and proposing future research
directions.
2. BACKGROUND LITERATURE
According to Zeithaml et. al. (2009), fast food restaurants are categorised as service enterprises.
Previous research has shown that fast food restaurant service quality has a positive impact on customer
satisfaction, revisit intention and customer purchasing decision (Law et. Al, 2004; Ying San et. Al,
2013).
-2-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
1) the degree of customer satisfaction with food, staff, dining area, relationship of quality -
price-quantity and delivery service
2) whether fast food customers’ demographic and behavioral characteristics affect satisfaction,
a qualitative research was conducted on a convenient sample of 220 customers of a "Goody's" fast
food outlet in Northern Greece. The subjects were asked to answer a questionnaire, which was
completed via personal interviews taken outside the researched chain restaurants in September 2014.
The questionnaire, apart from demographic information, includes questions about the respondents’
frequency of dining in fast food restaurants and their satisfaction with the food, staff, dining area, the
relationship of quality-price-quantity, delivery service, as well as overall satisfaction with fast food
restaurants and their views about any possible improvements. The questionnaire was assessed by
means of test -retest reliability on a sample of 15 subjects in five randomly chosen restaurants. An
analysis of the respondents' demographic characteristics is shown in Table 1.
-3-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The statistical analysis of data was performed through IBM SPSS and Kolmagorov-Smirnov and
Saphiro-Wilk regularity tests of data distribution, Mann-Whitney U non-parametric hypotheses test,
non-parametric Kruskal-Wallis H test and non parametric linear correlation coefficient rho of
Spearman; the significance level is a = 0.05.
-4-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Cronbach's
0.931 0.817 0.887 0.799 0.733 0.885
Alpha
The examination of the factor means related to the respondents’ satisfaction with fast food
restaurant services, originally, demonstrated that customer satisfaction with the staff (Mean = 3.91,
Stddev = 0.646) and delivery service (Mean = 3.85, Stddev = 1.016) is high. Slightly lower is the score
of participants’ satisfaction with the food (Mean = 3.91, Stddev = 0.646), whereas relatively moderate
satisfaction is demonstrated as regards the relationship of quality-quantity-price (Mean = 3.34, Stddev
= 1.031) and dining area (Mean = 3,23, Stddev = 0,330).
Given that under the Kolmogorov-Smirnov and Shapiro-Wilk tests the assumption of observation
normality for all factors is rejected (p-value <0.001), to investigate the impact of demographic
characteristics on customer satisfaction, non-parametric methods were employed.
In terms of gender, despite the individual differences of customer satisfaction with service delivery, it
was observed that gender did not significantly affect the mean scores of the research factors (p-value>
0.05 in all cases (Table 3).
On the other hand, it was demonstrated that age is statistically significant (Table 4) in relation to
customer satisfaction with the staff (p-value = 0.044), dining area (p-value = 0.010), the relationship of
quality-price-quantity (p-value = 0.001) and overall satisfaction with fast food restaurants (p-value
<0.001).
It is also worth noting that lower-income individuals exhibit higher satisfaction with the food (p-
value <0.001), whereas the higher the respondents’ income the higher their satisfaction with the
relationship of quality-price-quantity (p-value = 0.048). In addition, lower-income individuals exhibit
higher overall satisfaction with fast food restaurants (p-value = 0.049).
As regards dining out frequency (Table 5), it appears that fast food customers who rarely dine out or
those who dine out once a week exhibit statistically more significant satisfaction with staff service
delivery (p-value <0.001). In addition, it is demonstrated that –paradoxically- the customers who rarely
-5-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
eat out or those who dine out about once a month exhibit the highest satisfaction with the relationship
of quality-price-quantity in fast food restaurants (p-value <0.001). In contrast, the higher the dining out
frequency, the higher the respondents’ overall satisfaction (p-value <0.001).
In relation to the amount of money spent on fast food, it is observed that the lower the amount of
money spent in fast food restaurants (Table 6), the greater the degree of satisfaction with the dining
area (p-value = 0.013). In addition, more satisfied with the relationship of quality-price-quantity are the
respondents who usually spend up to 5 euro in fast food restaurants, followed by those who spend
much higher amounts (p-value <0.001). In contrast, customers’ overall satisfaction with fast food
restaurants seems to be higher for those who spend 5-50 euro (p-value <0.001).
Examining the relationship of fast food customer satisfaction with the type of restaurants they most
frequently prefer, it originally appears that, as regards satisfaction from food, the highest scores were
derived by souvlakeri customers, followed by customers who prefer creperies (p-value <0.001),
whereas satisfaction with food was lower in fast-food chains and fast food restaurants with
international cuisine. In addition, a statistically significant difference is observed in the mean scores of
customer satisfaction with the staff (p-value = 0.001); souvlakeri, fast food chain and bakery customers
exhibit the highest degree of satisfaction. Similarly, the mean scores of satisfaction with the delivery
service are as high (p-value <0.001). Finally, the overall satisfaction of souvlakeri and fast food chain
customers is obviously higher compared to the rest of the respondents (p-value = 0.019).
In terms of Spearman r correlation coefficient, it is observed (Table 7) that the respondents’ overall
satisfaction with fast food restaurants is positively and significantly correlated with the degree of
satisfaction with the staff (p = 0.419, p-value <0.001), dining area (p = 0.386, p-value <0.001) and the
relationship of quality- price -quantity (p = 0.554, p-value <0.001). The more satisfied the respondents
with the three above factors, the higher their overall satisfaction with fast food restaurants, as r
coefficient is observed to be positive and statistically significant in all paired correlations.
Finally, the process of correlation of customer satisfaction factors with the delivered services and
the customers’ perceptions about the components requiring improvements, indicate (Table 8) that the
lower the customer satisfaction with the staff (r = -0.148, p-value = 0.030), dining area (r = -0.304, p-
-6-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
value <0.001), and the relationship of quality-price-quantity (r = -0.483, p-value <0.001), the more
imperative the need for improvements in fast food restaurants.
In addition, as was predictable, overall satisfaction is negatively correlated to and statistically
significant with the respondents’ perceptions about the improvements required in fast food restaurants
(p = -0.506, p-value <0.001).
5. CONCLUSIONS
Product/service quality and its close relationship with customer satisfaction is given a particular
emphasis in modern strategic marketing, as it is generally suggested by academics and practitioners
that its impact on competitive advantage and, consequently, on business sustainability and revenue is
major. This enhances customer loyalty and new customer attraction, given that satisfied customers’
perceptions affect positive word-of-mouth.
Overall customer satisfaction is perceived as customer- and situational-specific. The present study,
in the context of the socio-economic crisis in Greece in the last few years, during which consumers’
lifestyles have changed, attempts to investigate customer satisfaction with food, staff, dining area,
relationship of quality-price-quantity and delivery service in a fast food chain restaurant. It also
explores whether fast food customers’ demographic and behavioral characteristics in Greece affect
their degree of satisfaction.
According to the research results, it was found that in fast food restaurants customer satisfaction is
significantly differentiated - in descending order- with staff service delivery, food quality, delivery
service, relationship of quality-price -quantity and, finally, dining area. It is suggested that the major
reason for dining in a particular fast food restaurant is, first, food quality and, secondly, service
delivery; in addition, the participants feel that overall satisfaction with fast food restaurants and the
relevant pricing policy must be improved.
It is, thus, ensued that, despite the fact that customers are generally satisfied with fast food services,
they suggest that high prices are the main deterrent to dining out, which implies that fast food chain
pricing should be reconsidered to enable fast food enterprises to affect customer satisfaction positively
and also enhance their competitive advantage.
Since correlation tests demonstrated that both age and income significantly affect customer satisfaction,
given that older customers consider the relationship of quality-price-quantity more significant, and
high-income ones are less satisfied with the specific factor, a focused redesign of the marketing mix
concerning restaurant style, new dishes, and primarily discount prices could be critical to the success of
the service industry at issue in contemporary social economic contexts.
To conclude, no generalization of the above findings should be made as the major limitation to the
specific research is the relatively small sample, in combination to spatial and geographical constraints,
given that the investigation was based on data drawn only from one fast food chain and in only one
area. Future research in Greece should involve larger and broad-scale research sampling and, in
addition, combine cross-national (cultural) comparative surveys focusing on factors affecting customer
satisfaction in different socio-economic environments.
-7-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
The data for this paper was collected as part of the dissertation by Mimilidis Konstantinos Department
of Accounting and Finance at the TEI of West Macedonia under the supervision of Dr Katarachia
Androniki.
REFERENCES
Andaleeb, S. S., & Conway, C., 2006. Customer satisfaction in the restaurant industry: An examination of the
transaction-specific model. Journal of Services Marketing, Vol.20 No.1, pp. 3-11.
Bitner, M.J., Booms, B.H., & Mohr, L.A.,1994. Critical service encounters: The employee's viewpoint. Journal of
Marketing, Vol 58, pp. 95-106.
Brady, M.K., Robertson, C.J. and Cronin, J.J. (2001), “Managing behavioral intentions in diverse cultural
environments: an investigation of service quality, service value, and satisfaction for American and Ecuadorian
fast-food customers”, Journal of International Management, Vol. 7, pp. 129-49.
Charondakis, D., 2012. Decrease in sales of 40% in fast food. Tovima online newspaper http://www.
tovima.gr/finance/article/?aid=447890[Accessed 10 January 2015]
Chumpitaz, R. and V. Swaen, 2002. Service quality and brand loyalty relationships: Investigating the mediating
effect of costumer satisfaction. Proceedings of the 31st European Marketing Academy Conference, Braga,
(Portugal).
Giese, J. L. and Cote, J. A. (2000). Defining consumer satisfaction. Academy of Marketing Science Review (on
line). Available at: www.amsreview.org/articles/giese01-2000.pdf [Accessed 10 May 2009]
Gilbert, G.R., Veloutsou, C., Goode, M.M.H. and Moutinho, L. (2004), “Measuring customer satisfaction in the
fast food industry: a cross-national approach”,The Journal of Services Marketing, Vol. 18 No. 5, pp. 371-83.
Hill, N. & Alexander, J., 2000. Handbook of customer satisfaction and loyalty measurement (2nd edition). London:
Gower Publishing Ltd.
Hume,M., and Mort, G.S., 2008. "Satisfaction in performing arts: the role of value?", European Journal of
Marketing, Vol. 42 Iss: 3/4, pp.311 – 326.
Iefimerida online newspaper embed (2013). The crisis hit the fast food -What shows research by Hellastat
http://www.iefimerida.gr/news/91687/η-κρίση-χτύπησε-και-το-fast-food-τι-δείχνει-έρευνα-της-hellastat
[Accessed 10 December 2014].
Kara, A., Kaynak, E. and Kucukemiroglu, O. (1995), “Marketing strategies for fastfood restaurants: a customer
view”, International Journal of Contemporary HospitalityManagement, Vol. 7 No. 4, pp. 16-22.
Kim, W.G., Ng, C.Y.N., & Kim, Y., 2009. Influence of institutional DINESERV on customer satisfaction, return
intention, and word-of-mouth. International Journal of Hospitality Management, Vol.28, pp. 10-17.
Law, A.K.Y., Hui, Y.V., and Zhao,X., 2004. Modeling Repurchase Frequency and Customer Satisfaction for Fast
Food Outlets. International Journal of Quality and Reliability Management, Vol.21 No.5, pp. 545-563.
Lee, M. and Ulgado, F.M., 1997. “Customer evaluation of fast-food services: a cross-national comparison”,
Journal of Services Marketing, Vol. 11 No. 1, pp. 39-52.
Manrai, L.A. & Manrai, A.K., 2007. A field study of customers’ switching behavior for bank services. Journal of
Retailing and Consumer Services. Vol. 14 No.), pp. 208-215.
Oliver, R.L., 1997.. Satisfaction: A Behavioral Perspective on the Consumer. Boston: McGraw-Hill.
Parasuraman, A., Zeithaml, V. A., and Berry, L. L.,1985. A Conceptual Model of Service Quality and Its
Implications for Future Research. Journal of Marketing Vol. 49, pp. 41–50.
Parker, C. & Mathews, B.P., 2001. Customer satisfaction: contrasting academic and consumers' interpretations.
Marketing Intelligence and Planning, Vol.19 No.1, pp. 38-44.
Qin, H. and Prybutok, V.R., 2008. “Determinants of customer-perceived service quality in fast food restaurants
(FFRs) and their relationship to customer satisfaction and behavioral intentions”, Quality Management
Journal, Vol. 15 No. 2, pp. 35-50.
Rust, R.T., and Oliver, R.L. (1994). Service quality: insights and managerial implications from the frontier. In
Rust, R.T. & Oliver, R.L. (Eds), Service quality: New directions in theory and practice, 241-68.
Salami, C.G.E. and Ajobo, R.T., 2012. Consumer Perceptions about Fast Food Restaurants in Asaba. Global
Journal of Management and Business Research, Vol.12 No. 1, pp. 75-81.
Stevens, P., Knuston, B., & Patton, M.,1995. DINESERV: A tool for measuring service quality in restaurants.
Cornell Hotel and Restaurant Administration Quarterly, Vol.36 No, 2, pp. 56-60.
Taylor, S. A., and Cronin, J. J., 1994. Modelling Patient Satisfaction and Service Quality. Journal of Health Care
Marketing. Vol.14 No.1, pp.34–44.
-8-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Ying San, Lim, Chen Ho, Tan, and Nya Ling, Tan, 2013. The Trend of Healthy Fast Food: How Malaysian’
Generation Y Makes the Purchase Decision? Australian Journal of Basic and Applied Sciences , Vol. 7 No.7,
pp. 631-638.
Zeithaml, V., Bitner, M., and Gremler, D., 2009. Services marketing: Integrating Customer Focus across the Firm.
5th ed. Boston: McGraw-Hill
-9-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Mental accounting, which is a fundamental part of the behavioral finance theory, goes beyond the constraints of
traditional paradigms and contributes to the development of new funding models. It involves people’s tendency to
create, depending on their individual characteristics, different mental accounts to which they assign experiences.
The present paper attempts a comprehensive discussion of the concept of mental accounting as well as of its
emergence and impact on the money market. It also outlines and highlights other cognitive and emotion errors,
which are directly related to the specific cognitive function and enhance its occurrence; in addition, it discusses
method s of avoiding mental accounting with a view to addressing irrational investment behavior.
KEYWORDS
Irrational behavioral, mental accounting, investment behavior, cognitive bias, emotional bias
1. INTRODUCTION
The new financial model of investment behavior has revealed weaknesses and limitations of the
hitherto dominant traditional finance model.
Behavioral finance has demonstrated that the market cannot always be effective and investors
cannot always be rational.
Financial markets are unpredictable; investors and all those involved in its activities are typically
people with biases and cognitive and emotional errors. Their psychological attributes and special traits
and personalities motivate irrational thinking and wrong investment policies.
A cognitive error frequently made by people, and, more specifically, by investors, is mental
accounting, which is defined as people’s tendency to generate different mental accounts and register
events and situations they have experienced in their effort to achieve a better psychological
management.
The present paper provides a generalized discussion of the concept of mental accounting, and, in
parallel, attempts a more elaborated analysis in the framework of financial activities. In addition, it
discusses the cognitive and emotional errors which are directly related to mental accounting and affect
its occurrence. Finally, the paper outlines the methods of preventing the specific irrational mental effect
with a view to achieving rationality, good investment decisions and the desired returns.
-10-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The concept, which was first introduced by Thaler in 1980, is defined as the set of cognitive
operations used by individuals to codify, categorize and evaluate economic activities. Thaler contends
that mental accounting is one of the pillars on which the entire financial behavior is based. Similarly,
Hirshleiper (2001) argues that mental accounting is a type of narrow framing which “involves keeping
track of gains and losses related to decisions in separate mental accounts, and to re-examine each
account only intermittently when action-relevant”.
People generate mentally different expenses accounts in their budgets for activities, such as
entertainment, food, travel and clothing. If too much money is spent on one category this will delay
purchase of necessary items in the same category despite the fact that money is still spent on items of
other categories (Becher, 2011).
Overall, people employ mental accounts to manage events differently, and their actions are affected
by the method of management. For instance, people behave differently when they use credit cards
rather than cash; for example, they tend to bet more money on a lottery game when they use a credit
card instead of cash.
Mental behavior has disproved the utility theory, according to which all decisions are evaluated on
the basis of their expected utility. Psychological attitudes and cognitive thinking generate irrational
actions and behaviors, and rational thinking is abandoned. It becomes, therefore, evident that rational
thinking is highly significant and it is imperative that it be monitored.
-12-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
with respect to a reference point (Mattos and Garcia, 2009). Prior losses may cause risk aversion,
whereas prior gains may induce higher risk-taking.
In effect, the house money effect causes people and investors to deviate from rational behavioral
patterns and, thus, either derive lower gains or are financially ruined.
-13-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
It is required that financial behavior be implemented as an investment strategic tool. Awareness of the
new financial paradigm can prevent irrationality. The study and knowledge of psychological, emotional
and mental implications generate rational investment decisions. Awareness of heuristics, of cognitive
and emotional errors and also of biases prevents their occurrence and, therefore, irrationality.
Awareness and endorsement of mental operations (for example, making different accounts) enables
successful management. The study and awareness of psychological, emotional and mental implications,
as well as the presentation and analysis of the new investment behavioral model is essential to all
investors and employees involved in the financial sector. Understanding the particular behavior, which
is likely to be exhibited during the investment decision making processes is fundamental to making
proper-correct decisions.
5. CONCLUSION
People’s tendency to categorize situations and processes in different mental accounts, in order to
achieve a better psychological management, is called mental accounting. The significance of mental
accounting and its impact on behavior, and, more specifically, on investment processes is great.
Irrationality deriving from mental games has a negative impact on people’s behavior and investment
decisions. By jointly studying other biases and cognitive errors which affect and enhance mental
accounting, people can have a more thorough insight into one of the main reasons of irrationality.
People’s risk-taking attitudes, their tendency to exhibit specific behaviors depending on how
successful prior procedures were, the preference to segregate gains and integrate loss are associated
with the generation and enhancement of mental accounting, which is prevented by studying behavioral
errors.
Investment errors that cause biases, psychological-emotional errors as well as errors of the mind are
prevented by studying and applying the new dominant theory of behavioral finance. Rationality is
restored and maintained as long as human weaknesses and personality differences are identified. In
addition, irrationality can be prevented by becoming aware of the meaning, utility and exchangeability
of money. Portfolios should be treated as aggregate net assets. The discussion of mental accounting in
terms of human behavior and its impact on the stock market enables realizing the significance of
behavioral finance and establishing it as a dominant financial paradigm.
Research in the impact of mental accounting on people who work and invest in financial sectors will
be a fundamental tool to address irrational investment behavior and restore rationality. Mental
accounting causes investors’ irrationality and non-rational investment decision making. As it affects
-14-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
how investors perceive expenditure and future savings, as well as gains and losses, its significance in
financial markets is huge and its impact on the financial activities of everyday life is enormous
(Charupat & Deaves, 2003).
REFERENCES
Alexakis, Ch. and Xanthakis, M., 2008. Behavioral Finance, Stamoulis Publications, Greece
Becher, J., 2011. Mental Accounting Explains Why You Buy Things You Don't Need, Forbes Brand Voice ,
http://www.forbes.com/sites/sap/2011/06/29/mental-accounting-explains-why-you-buy-things-you-dont-need/
(accessed 23/11/2013)
Charupat N., and Deavens, R. 2003. How behavioral finance can assist financial planners, Michael DeGroote
School of Business Germany, pp. 1-13.
Festinger, L., 1957. A theory of cognitive dissonance, Stanford: Stanford Univ. Press, California.
Frino, A., Grant, J.,and Johnstone D., 2008. The House Money Effect and Local Traders on the Sydney Futures
Exchange. Pacific-Basin Finance Journal, Vol. 16, pp. 8-25.
Hirshleifer, D., 2001. Investor Psychology and Asset Pricing, Journal of Finance, Vol. 56, No 4, pp.1533-1597
Investopedia,http://www.investopedia.com/university/behavioral_finance/behavioral5.asp
Khan, U., and Dhar, R., 2010. Price-Framing Effects on the Purchase of Hedonic and Utilitarian Bundles, Journal
of Marketing Research, Vol. XLVII , pp. 1090–1099
Liu, Y., Tsai, C., Wang M., and Zhu, N., 2006. House Money Effect: Evidence from Market Makers at Taiwan
Futures Exchange, pp. 1-55
Mangot M., 2012, 50 Psychological Experiments for Investors, Wiley, United States.
Mattos F., and Garcia, P., 2009. The Effect of Prior Gains and Losses on Current Risk-Taking Using Quantile
Regression, Paper presented at the NCCC-134 Conference on Applied Commodity Price Analysis, Forecasting,
and Market Risk Management St Louis, Missouri, pp.1-14.
Nofsinger J., 2001. The Psychology of Investing, Prentice Hall, New Jersey
Nofsinger, J., 2001.Behavioral Finance, John Wiley &Sons, U.S.A.
Nosfinger J., 2008, Psychology of Investing, Pearson Series in Finance, USA.
Phung A., 2012. Behavioral Finance: Key Concepts - Mental Accounting,
Phung, A. 2008. Behavioral Finance, Key Concepts- Confirmation and Hindsight Bias Retrieved from
http://www.investopedia.com/university/behavioral_finance/behavioral6.asp (accessed 5/1/2015)
Png, I., Reza, S., and Ho, T., 2014. Sunk Cost Fallacy in Driving the World’s Costliest Cars, Centre for
Behavioural Economics, NUS Business School, pp. 1-45.
Pohl, A., 2013. Mental Accounting: Is it good to have accounts for different things?, Finance with reason,
http://financewithreason.com/mental-accounting-accounts-different/ (1/3/2015)
Prakash, A., 2013Are you victim of Mental Accounting, http://theindianeconomist.com/are-you-a-victim-of-
mental-accounting/ (accessed, 28/2/2015).
Shams, M., Kordlouie M., and Dezfuli, H.,.2012. The Effect of Mental Accounting on Sales Decisions of
Stockholders in Tehran Stock Exchange, World Applied Sciences Journal, Vol. 20, N.6, pp.842-847
Shefrin, H., 2001. Behavioral Corporate Finance. National Bureau of Economic Research, Vol.14, No 3. pp 21-33.
Statman, Μ., 2010 Countries and Culture in Behavioral Finance, CFA Institute Conference Proceedings Quarterly,
pp. 38-44.
Thaler, R., 1980.Mental Accounting and Consumer Choice, Marketing Science, Vol 4, No 3, pp 199-214.
Thaler, R., 1999. Mental Accounting Matters, Journal of Behavioral Decision Making, Vol.12, pp.183-206
Thaler, R., Johnson, E., 1990. Gambling with the House Money and Trying to Break Even, Management Science,
Vol. 36, No. 6, pp. 643-652
Thaler, R.H., 1999, Mental Accounting Matters, Journal of Behavioral Decision Making, USA.
Zhou R., and Pham M., 2004. Promotion and Prevention across Mental Accounts: When Financial Products
Dictate Consumers’ Investment Goals, Journal of consumer research, Vol. 31, pp. 125-135.
-15-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
The article analyzes measures taken by the Bulgarian central bank and governmental authorities in response to the
occurrence of a problematic situation arose with depleted liquidity of the Corporate Commercial Bank AD (CCB)
in June 2014. Building on the perception of duties completed in one of the banks placed under conservatorship,
this study aims to identify the factors that appear to influence different approaches to policies into the banking
sector. The empirical analysis was performed in Bulgaria over the period 2004–20014. The results show that
profitability was replaced by market power as the main determinant of bank strategic actions during the crisis.
Only top two banks were able to sustain the absolute numbers of their profit, this make them contribute from 71%
to 63% of the entire profit in the system from 2012 till 2014. Further discussion addresses different policies
implemented by banks under local use and control, compared to banks having roots in continental Europe and
Greek banks present on the Bulgarian market. During period of six years before the crisis, market power and bank
profit were more correlated, compared to the last four years from the studied period. The pronounced role of the
global financial turmoil causes sharp decrease in bank-to-bank money placements and exacerbation of the problem
of affiliated non-banking businesses linked to banks under local use and control. The findings reveal substantial
time lag between global and local periods of crisis. Financial problems related to the fourth biggest bank in
Bulgaria are mostly due to immature political culture, missing internal control, weak supervision performed by the
central bank and lacking coherence among governmental authorities, including public prosecution. This should
offer one more challenge to European supra-national institutions to enhance integrity, to build cohesive and unified
bank supervision, to support financial stability and values of shared destiny for our common good.
KEYWORDS
banks, competition, crisis, financial regulation, political risks
1. INTRODUCTION
The analysis of correlations between profitability and the market power has been regular topic in the
academic studies on banking. Davis (1985) and Davis (2004) revealed that profit objectives were one
of the main characteristics forming an excellent bank. According to Davis, bank excellence did not
depend on organizational structure, managerial style and business-environmental factors, such as
regulatory constraints, market structure and local competition. Davis noted that open culture, strong
shared values among the managerial staff, customer-driven orientation, willingness to innovate, matrix-
based management information system and strong credit process are the key elements to distinguish
excellent banks. In contrary to Davis the market power hypothesis provides arguments that
environmental factors and especially the high level of market concentration facilitates banks making
profit by setting higher prices to customers. Most of the banks use to operate in oligopolistic markets
historically matured in all economically developed countries. Prior the world financial crisis of
2007/2008 deregulations, technological developments and globalization have been constantly
increasing competition in the banking sector. Davis (2004) admits difficulties to predict success or
failure of a bank. This raises the question on what are the optimal transformation strategies for banks to
consider. Europe progresses towards establishment of a Single Supervisory Mechanism, standardized
stress tests, unified rules on managerial practices and remunerations and it is important to study
consequences this trend brings to banks. The article offers Bulgarian viewpoint over these European
dynamics by exhibiting particular banks’ strategies to adapt to uncertain economics and regulations.
Empirical evidence suggests that regulatory actions taken in resolution of bank failures may vary
significantly between territories and cultures. When faced with individual bank failures bank
-16-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
supervisors and governmental authorities enforce a private-sector resolution. During systemic bank
failures, it was almost certain, that liquidity support based on blanked government guarantees should be
granted. However, the literature has not yet investigated determinants of the role of a central bank and
governmental activities having none bailout policy on place.
This article analyzes correlation between market power and profit generated by banks under local use
and control, compared to banks having roots in continental Europe and Greek banks present on the
Bulgarian market for ten years period between 2004 and 2014. Special attention is given to the
measures taken by the Bulgarian National Bank (BNB, the central bank) and governmental authorities
in response to the occurrence of a problematic situation arose with depleted liquidity of the Corporate
Commercial Bank AD (CCB) in June 2014. The uniqueness of the research is examining bank industry
dynamics prior, during and after a conservatorship period lasting for six months! Probably it is the
longest conservatorship period in the modern banking history of EU. The importance of such a research
corresponds to the last issued European Commission staff working document, Country Report Bulgaria
2015. It is all about enhanced level of competences experts must have in purpose to understand, discuss
and timely prepare reasonable advices when aiming prevention and correction of country local
imbalances.
-17-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Bulgaria had one of the best performing housing market in the world for few years around 2006. The
global financial crisis accelerated market fluctuations; this way caused deterioration of the real estate
market. Neither governmental regulations nor private initiatives addressed the meltdown of assets.
When foreign banks gradually implemented disinvestment strategies, local banks increasingly insert
into conglomerate structures in purpose to grab assets and business opportunities.
Many analysts considered Bulgaria provides very attractive conditions for doing business. The
introduction of a currency board in July 1997 was followed by automatic fixing of the exchange rate of
BGN 1.95583 to one euro subsequent to 1 January 2002. Bulgarian central bank discontinued direct
lending to the budget, refinancing of commercial banks and open market operations. The currency
board regulations mandated the central bank to continually maintain domestic base money strictly
equivalent to the level of foreign reserves. Bulgarian taxation neared Cyprus, having corporate tax
reduced to 15% in 2006 and further to 10% in 2007. Personal income tax rate came to a 10% flat rate,
effective from January 1st, 2008. Having all these favorable conditions it was reasonable to expect the
boom and growth would be back. This motivated the strong appetite of the local banks to tap any
opportunity and to acquire any strategic asset from their retreated counterparts.
A trouble with the fourth biggest bank in the country exploded suddenly! It started with comments in
the media, announced by CCB’s executive director, that there is a tension between leaders in the bank,
announced on June 13, 2014. The tension has escalated with publications in the media on June 18,
2014 that the Deputy Governor of the central bank, in charge of Banks’ Supervision, is being
investigated by the public prosecution and is on leave "until the conclusion of the proceedings".
Charges have been pressed against him under the Criminal code for criminal abuse of power as related
to default loans in a “big bank”. The panic started and people run to this “big bank” to withdraw their
deposits! June 20, 2014 at 11.40 a.m., the Bulgarian National Bank received a written notice from the
management of the Corporate Commercial Bank that bank’s liquidity had been depleted and the bank
had suspended making payments and conducting all types of banking transactions. On these grounds
the Corporate Commercial Bank has been placed under conservatorship and the same measure applied
to its subsidiary the Commercial Bank Victoria. Although central bank declared that the liquidity
shortage in the CCB’s group is an isolated case and is not connected with the rest of the banking
system, depositors withdraw Euro 400 million in cash just on Friday, June 27, 2014 from another, even
“bigger” bank. Then, the European Union gave Bulgarian government to provide BGN 3.3 billion
(EUR 1.67 billion) in state aid for banks, so within one weekend the tensions have been overcome. The
central bank proudly announced that the banking sector has returned to its normal functioning, when
the Prime Minister announced government’s resignation as of August 6, 2014.
4. RESEARCH METHOD
First and foremost we positioned studied phenomenon in the context of the developments of a banking
industry viewed from the risks of judiciary, prosecution and/or political interventions.
This article employ research methodology approximating the one initially introduced by Stiroh and all
(2003) when analyzing deregulation effects on banks’ strategy. First it describes chronologically the
CCB’s case. Then it explores banks’ strategic choices in four segments. Correlations between bank
profitability and subsequent change in market share helps to interpret the causal factor, indicative for
the studied competitive forces.
Official press-releases issued by the central bank, governmental authorities and publications in the
business media, when related to the development of Bulgarian banking industry and/or to the Corporate
Commercial Bank have been analyzed and codded. All codded events, plus actual actions related to
prosecution and legislation has been chronologically listed. Rumors and opinions that cannot be traced
in legal documents and/or official press releases have been excluded from the list. Chronological map
of events helps to understand causes and effects in others’ banks responses to CCB’s case. This article
keeps neutral position. It avoids to accuse and/or to judge. Still ongoing role of the public prosecution
and the court needs a separate study.
The empirical analysis was performed on Bulgarian banks over the period 2004–20014. It separates
banks in four groups to better understand influences of their home country into their strategic action
into the host country. The core discussion unveils different policies implemented by banks linked to
local use and control, compared to banks having roots in continental Europe and Greek banks present
on the Bulgarian market. Special attention is given to the top two market leaders. Information related to
CCB’s case, banks’ ownership and numerical data are derived from publicly available reports in
Bulgarian National Bank (the central bank) and processed by the author. This article uses values of
banks’ total assets as a measure to derive market share and to assess market power, when profit
-18-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
actually means net result as reported on respective year-end. Possible transfer of domestic loans from a
bank to another, outside the country has not been considered as materially important.
This article avoids discussions related to what caused a CCB’s crisis to occur. The uniqueness of the
case most likely originates from unusual relations between Mr. Tsvetan Vassilev, Chairman of the
Supervisory Board of the bank and Mr. Delyan Peevski, somehow related to the State Agency
“National Security”. A number of city rumors suggest link between several newspapers, TV7 Group
and bank activities. Gossips link the bank with political party Bulgaria Without Censorship. The party
ran for the first time in the May 2014 European Parliament election, earning one seat and joined the
soft eurosceptic group of European Conservatives and Reformists. Recent judicial proceeding on the
involvements of the judge Roumiana Chenalova from the Sofia City Court implies strong correlations
between litigation resolutions signed by her and activities undertaken by the Corporate Commercial
-19-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Bank, Mr. Tsvetan Vassilev, Mr. Delyan Peevski, some other bossy personalities and companies
related to them. Although it needs criminological research to be undertaken, most of the bankers in
Bulgaria know the stories and accordingly adjust banks’ policies!
Central bank revoked CCB’s banking license and petitioned the court to open bankruptcy proceedings,
as it found that the significant portion of the capital increase, especially in period October 2011 till
March 2014 was financed through loans originating from the bank itself. Although national regulation
did not prohibit such a method, EU Regulation 575/2013 in force as of 2014 explicitly forbids this
practice.
Surprisingly or not, Commission for Disclosures spotted one of the syndics recently appointed in CCB,
among 8 out of 26 bank syndics as linked with the State Security before 1989. Probably this is one
more reason Bulgaria to be the EU country with lowest and still diminishing perception of judicial
independence (European Commission 2015 EU Justice Scoreboard).
market, lack of political vision and local market imperfections, make bank to change its strategy. Soon
after that MKB Group, Allied Irish Bank, Crédit Agricole, NLB dd. and Tokushukai announced their
divestment programs. The only buyers were Bulgarian banking, financial or entrepreneurial groups.
The dynamics in the relationship between bank ownership and market share are presented in Table 4.
Crisis period is determined to 2012/2014 as negative results reported in two segments (Table 5) and
highest levels of correlations between net results and total assets for these periods (Table 7).
Furthermore, due to extraordinary situation in CCB, 2014 is the year of shock.
Decelerated economic growth in home country leads to decelerating loan supply in the host country.
This is confirmed by the decline in both market share and profit of Greek banks and banks from
continental Europe during the period 2012 – 2014. It seems ownership does not influence performance
only at the level of top two market leaders.
Table 6. Dynamics in relationship between bank ownership and net profit margin
Prior crisis Crisis Shock
Net Profit Margin (%) Average
2004 2006 2008 2010 2012 2013 2014
Top two banks 2.36 2.57 2.82 1.46 1.89 1.83 1.90 2.12
Continental Europe without top two banks 1.45 1.62 1.64 0.49 0.41 -0.08 0.97 0.93
Banks with Greek ownership 2.26 2.08 1.70 0.34 -0.24 0.23 0.28 0.95
Use and control linked to Bulgaria 0.94 1.11 1.33 1.05 0.50 0.47 0.26 0.81
TOTAL 1.74 1.90 1.99 0.82 0.69 0.68 0.88 1.24
Table 6 exhibits that the Bulgarian banks has lowest net profit margin compared to the foreign banks.
One interpretation is that any of the local banks are not the only endeavor of their owners. Most likely
other priorities stipulated by the owners blunted competitive forces in their banks and weakened the
link between performance and growth.
Table 7. Correlation between Net Results (NR) and Total Assets (TA) for selected periods (when over 0.5)
-22-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Results from Table 7 imply that the financial statements of banks in Bulgaria echo the global financial
crisis with three years delay (around 2010)! It is to prove that Bulgaria stays distant from global
financial markets. Some researchers report that the bigger is the power of the foreign banks, the more
severe crisis it will produce into the host country, in comparison with countries that had a smaller
presence of foreign banks (Cull and Martínez-Peria 2007). Also Stiglitz (2002) are questioning the role
of foreign banks as providers of financial stability for smaller economics. This is exactly part of the
political debate in Bulgaria, as country should decide to join the Single Supervisory Mechanism or to
stay aside and gain benefits only by hosting European banks, subject to this level of supervision.
Whatever decision would be taken, country needs primarily to enhance banks’ internal control
mechanisms, prudent supervision and the maturity of the political class.
7. CONCLUSION
The uniqueness of the Bulgarian market environment, political risks and regulatory constraints are
illustrated by provided chronology in formation, growth and deficiencies as related to the Corporate
Commercial Bank. We strongly believe in Bulgarian National Bank profound statement that the case
with Corporate Commercial Bank is an insulated case and Bulgarian banking system remains sound
and stable. This was the main reason to analyze reactions other banks have on shock in 2014. Still
unanswered question is whether the regulated banking industry offers more stable business playground
than other industries. Globalization provides banks with more opportunities to enter or exit particular
market, not only by following customers and wealth-skimming, but also exploiting regulatory
arbitrage. Potentially biggest banks could have more power to exercise regulatory capture. Strategic
choices executed by the top two market leaders need further attention, as it seems they are the real
winners out of the crisis. Hopefully CCB crisis will attract more attention and support from supra-
national institutions in Europe to assist local regulator.
Banks usually devote vast resources to ensure compliance with all regulations and yet repeatedly they
are sanctioned for not doing enough. Notwithstanding the serious regulatory efforts for supervising
banks on the European level, little considered thought has been given to the quality of local bank
supervision. Possibility a central bank to adopt disruptive strategy rather than bailout a bank are
sometimes less obvious. From a central bank point of view, getting the balance right in executing the
power, but still sharing the responsibility to protect stability is neither easy nor uncontroversial. The
article seeks to address this deficit in a practical and informed manner in comparing responses given by
different market players to profit versus market power. The findings reveal that problems in the bank
industry are mostly due to immature political culture, missing internal control, weak supervision
performed by the central bank and lacking coherence among governmental authorities, including public
prosecution. Studied phenomenon could further enhance understanding on variations in legal system
and practices, in purpose to enhance European identity, to build cohesive and unified bank supervision,
so to support prosperity, stability and values of shared destiny for our common good.
REFERENCES
-23-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Cull, R.; Martínez-Peria, M. S. (2007) Foreign bank participation and crises in developing countries, World Bank
Policy Research Working Paper No. 4128. Washington: World Bank.
Davis S.I., (1985) Excellence in Banking London Macmillan
Davis S.I., (2004) Excellence in Banking - Revisited! London Palgrave Macmillan
European Commission 2015 EU Justice Scoreboard Brussels, 09 March 2015 http://ec.europa.eu/justice/effective-
justice/scoreboard/index_en.htm
European Commission 2015, Country Report Bulgaria 2015, Including an In-Depth Review on the prevention and
correction of macroeconomic imbalances, Brussels, 26 February 2015 http://ec.europa.eu/europe2020/making-it-
happen/country-specific-recommendations/index_en.htm
Stiglitz, J. 2002. Globalization and Its Discontents. New York: W.W. Norton & Company.
Stiroh K.J., Strahan, P.E. 2003 Competitive Dynamics of Deregulation: Evidence from U.S. Banking. Journal of
Money, Credit & Banking (Ohio State University Press). Oct2003, Vol. 35 Issue 5, p801-828. 28p.
-24-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
1
Agriculture University of Tirana/Albania, amadelija@gmail.com
2
South East European University/Albania, s.qirici@seeu.edu.mk
ABSTRACT
Orientation towards the market economy and economic policy development and growth within the country's
macroeconomic stability remains a key factor for ensuring economic and social emancipation of our country.
The Albanian economy, as an economy of a developing country characterized by a positive trend upward despite
the restraining effects caused by the global crisis. Macroeconomic indicators are demonstrating consistency; the
financial system is healthy and economic activity making progress. At the same time, the diversification of the
local economy to respond to the demands of the free market, increasing competition and the dynamics of
development, as well as untapped potential in agriculture necessitates the strengthening of relations and
cooperation structures for financing sustainable development country.
Experience has shown that microfinance (MFI) has been a powerful tool for the development of small and medium
enterprises (SMEs) to agribusiness, playing an ever more crucial in improving the living conditions and welfare of
the population, especially in rural areas, the creation of new work by contributing to the economic development of
the country.
Agribusiness is an integral part of the national economy and requires continued financial support. On the other
hand, micro-credit institutions through their branches as complementary parts of the system are the best choice,
faster and long-term agribusiness. The rapid growth of this sector is expected to continue as a result of increased
funding needs, especially in rural areas.
This research will study the role of microfinance sector to increase opportunities for entrepreneurs to increase their
investments in innovative activities in promoting new methods of production and to increase their productive
capacity.
This research will study the role of microfinance sector to increase opportunities for entrepreneurs to increase their
investments in innovative activities in promoting new methods of production and to increase their productive
capacity by bringing a case fairly present the operates in our country more than 20 years and is a leader in
providing financial products in rural areas, Albanian Savings and Credit Union.
The findings of this research thanks will show that:
a) Involvement of SMEs in microfinance brings increased level of profitability of SMEs.
b) Microfinance plays a significant role in the future development of SMEs in Albania.
c) Increase the commitment and capacity of MFIs to support SME development allows for the improvement of
policies to stimulate agribusiness, as the legal framework and to create a better investment climate, as well as
contribution major interest groups that influence and are influenced by the Albanian agribusiness.
KEYWORDS
SMEs, MFIs, Credits, Agribusiness, Funding Sources
1. INTRODUCTION
Agriculture is considered as the backbone of developing countries and has great potential in
supporting the development, growth and poverty reduction (Zeller, 2003). Despite the fundamental
contribution in the development of agriculture for developing countries, remains an underdeveloped
sector and people living in rural areas are generally poor. For this reason, agricultural development
requires full attention to the support of micro-enterprises in Albania.
-25-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Agribusiness is an integral part of the national economy and requires continued financial support.
On the other hand, micro-credit institutions through their branches as complementary parts of the
system are the best choice, faster and long-term agribusiness. The rapid growth of this sector is
expected to continue as a result of increased funding needs, especially in rural areas.
Microfinance has its origins in the early 1980s, where governments and international donors felt
and believed that the poor, farmers, seeking low-interest loans as a way to increase production to meet
the vital needs of the family, on the other governments saw as a catalyst and a factor for increasing
productivity in the economy. Since 1980 microfinance as a field (science) has increased steadily and
fast.
Private donors, governments have supported and actively support and encourage the activities of
microfinance as a foundation for a much broader scope, and financial sustainability. In general,
microfinance services can help people with low incomes to reduce risk, improve management, increase
productivity, have higher profitability of investments, increase income through self-employment and
improve quality of their life and subordinates.
Financial services usually include savings, credit, and in some cases, payment services and
insurance. In addition to financial intermediation, many microfinance institutions provide social
services like formations intermediate groups, self-esteem development and training among members of
a group management skills.
Farmers and rural entrepreneurs to develop their activities need financial support for the purchase of
inputs, equipment and investment for their farms.
Increased mechanization of agriculture, demand for equipment, inputs and investments for
agricultural and livestock farms, requires the provision of financial services in rural areas.
Farmers and rural enterprises often do not have sufficient access to long-term loans to finance their
production activities due to the seasonal nature of agricultural production, ownership problems and
difficulties in providing collateral, ownership of farms and small surface fragmented, are some of the
reasons that have generated a tightening of banks and other financial institutions associated with
agricultural lending.
Development of agricultural sector in terms of market economy requires a financial support for the
realization of investments.
In this context extremely challenging for micro finance organizations, ASC Union, as a leading
financial institution in rural areas had the objective to increase the quality of the management of its
existing portfolio by strengthening and further improve credit assessment and for the support and
agricultural development in Albania.
The essence of this paper is to contribute to the theoretical and practical literature to strengthen
relations microfinance sector entrepreneurs and small and medium enterprises (SMEs) as well as
adjusting the financing condition to the requirements of the private sector and agriculture in Albania.
The findings of this research thanks will show that:
~ Involvement of SMEs in microfinance brings increased level of profitability of SMEs.
~ Microfinance plays a significant role in the future development of SMEs in Albania.
~ Increase the commitment and capacity of MFIs to support SME development allows for the
improvement of policies to stimulate agribusiness, as the legal framework and to create a better
investment climate, as well as contribution major interest groups that influence and are influenced by
the Albanian agribusiness.
-26-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Further studies conducted in this field suggest that 'glitch' in liquidity and low access is finance for
SMEs constitute the biggest obstacle for them (Green, 2002). SMEs have limited access to financial
services offered by formal financial institutions to meet their needs for liquidity and investments
(Kessy and Temu, 2009).
However, the generation of self-employment in SMEs, requires investment in working capital, and
low levels of income such capital accumulation can be difficult. In such circumstances, the loan can
help the poor to accumulate capital and investment in employment generating activities (Hossain,
1988). Microfinance enables customers to protect, diversify and increase their incomes by reducing
their vulnerability to shocks to income and consumption (Robinson, 2002).
According Grade (1984), loans enable individuals or enterprises enjoy the benefit of economies of
scale and new technology. Availability of credit to small businesses and families with low incomes
would could increase their economic power and eventually break the vicious circle "of low income -
low savings - low investment - low income" (Yunus, 1984).
The banking system shows no interest in SME financing, as required amounts of them are very
small and insignificant by commercial banks. Commercial banks are considered as catalysts for
economic development of the country through mobilization and profitability by providing large
amounts of loans that they offer. In this respect, they consider as dangerous and nonprofit funding to
rural households and businesses, excluding from their target group.
In a study done by Chijoriga and Cassimon (1999) revealed that, to borrow from MFIs involves
high transaction costs due to procedures and long bureaucratic for loan review and decision. The study
also noted that asymmetric information between borrower and lender is very high and this led to the
establishment of rules to tighten the monitoring and supervision of borrowers from MFIs.
Despite higher transaction costs, SMEs are using funding sources MFIs to further promote and
increase their activity in the country, so it is important to analyze the influence and impact of
microfinance to SMEs with cost MFIs real. Therefore, this study aims to investigate the impact of
microfinance services in the growth of SMEs in Albania, as well as to identify the benefits of
microcredit, and to assess the share of costs arising from the obligation of the loan compared to the
contribution of MFIs first in Albania in view of improving family welfare SMEs.
According Alemayehu (2010), considered microfinance institutions offering financial services to
clients with low income or solidarity lending groups including consumers and the self-employed, who
traditionally lack access to services offered by banking institutions.
Microfinance also known as microcredit, small loans are considered as provided for poor families to
promote self-employment and income generation (Fazl, Hasan & Abed, 2006).
Yacob (2007) believes that microfinance is the financing of loans, savings, and other basic financial
services to the poor. According to the Grameen Foundation, microfinance is often called "bank for the
poor '.
1
Raykat Bank Indonesia
2
Microfinance Information eXchange
-27-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The importance of microfinance in development is strengthened with the launch of the Microcredit
Summit in 1997. The Summit aims to reach 175 million poorest families across the globe, especially
the women of those families, with credit for financial and business services other self-employed until
the end of 20153 (Microcredit Summit, 2005). Finally, the UN declared 2005 as the International Year
of Microcredit.
3. MICROFINANCE IN ALBANIA
Microfinance is the most important strategy to fight poverty and to develop small and medium
enterprises in Albania.
Microcredit in the past 30 years has played a significant role in the economic, social and political
situation in the world. He is regarded as an alternative solution to the problems of economic, social,
cultural, affecting countries in transition, developing countries and not only.
This is happening in our country in the last 2 decades. But microcredit is just one of the services
that microfinance institutions offer their clients. Poor people and excluded from access to common
services banks, as deemed inappropriate and lack collateral can use microloans through loans to small
amounts as a means to gain access to financial services.
So based on the idea that microfinance lending system is open to all. Most of the population
excluded from financial services, working in the informal market and live in a survival economy level,
and to a loan no matter how small to allow them to self-employed entrepreneurs can increase their
standard of living and ensuring profits.
In many poor countries, self-employment in the informal sector occupies more than 50% of the
workforce and access to microcredit enables vulnerable people, building a profitable business through a
small private company.
Microfinance in Albania offered by microfinance institutions and savings and loan. The most
important of them are: Albanian Union of Savings and Credit (including related companies), Society of
Financial First Development (FAF-Sha), NOA-Sha, (former Albanian Partner in Micro), the Fund
Besa, VisionFund Albania LLC, JEHONA Union and the services offered by commercial banks,
ProCredit Bank Albania.
3
The original objective was to reach 100 million by 2005, but members of the Microcredit Summit Latin
American / Caribbean in April 2005, these objectives are changed (Microcredit Summit, 2005).
-28-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
In general, most institutions still rely heavily on international donors and access to social and
commercial investment is underdeveloped. Although microcredit entities have played a significant role
in expanding credit to sectors of the economy that have received less services, the scope of their
activity is still very small and products and services offered are still limited. Microcredit entities are
concentrated in trade, services and agriculture; however, the limited scope of their operations still
leaves without completing an application, theoretically great, credit to agriculture.
Most of their activities remained focused on trade, which accounts for 45% of their total portfolio
of loans. Thus, in farming activities accounted for only a small part of the total loan portfolio of
microcredit entities. This volume of loans is almost equal to that offered by commercial banks is still
far less than the potential demand for credit in the countryside, taking into account the importance of
agricultural activities in GDP in Albania.
In Albania, the number of people who have access to microcredit is smaller compared to other
countries of the region. However, the industry focus on larger scale to the poor. Microfinance loans are
relatively small (when measured as a percentage of GDP per capita), compared with those of other
countries in the region. In general, this measure usually means that, in Albania, the expansion of
microfinance operations is deeper and the center of attention are borrowers with lower incomes.
Rural areas in Albania constitute about 80% of the territory and about 53% of the population lives
and works in these areas mainly in the agricultural sector, accounting for almost 20% of GDP. Public
policies of the government in recent years have been reducing poverty and promoting development in
rural areas.
In these areas there is a lack of financial services:
• As a result of great poverty;
• Customers of these areas are considered very riskier;
• Property law in Albania is not clearly defined and that makes many farmers could not
prove ownership of their land.
Precisely in these areas play an important role in financial unions which have started their activities
since 1992 with the support of donors like USAID, UNPD, World Bank etc. Financial unions that
operate in the country financial consist of two unions and relevant networks of savings and credit
societies: the Union of Savings and Credit (ASCUNION) and echo Union, where the Union of Savings
and Credit has the largest share activity to develop these subjects (about 98% of total assets). Unions
are responsible for the monitoring and support of the activity of the network of SCAs.
These subjects cover especially rural areas and around cities and meet the needs of a large clientele
by concentrating their services in countries where commercial banks are largely missing. Microfinance
institutions and savings and credit societies are successful institutions and are considered to have a
significant impact on social and financial strata which they serve.
In particular, in rural areas has been proven that these financial institutions have helped farmers to
overcome the emergency phase and, subsequently, have encouraged the development, creating some of
the first financial structures in villages, as well as making it possible for villages to manage credit and
other development projects.
The main investments have been improvements in physical infrastructure, roads, schools, hospitals
and waterworks and sewer. Savings and credit unions raise funds from their members with a very low
interest rate but most of their capital and global finances passing financed by donors provide these
funds as loans to other members. Personal property as collateral serve as livestock production,
greenhouses, etc. receivable. Microcredit is the main financial product that these unions offer their
members as farmers or small and medium enterprises.
As we can see from the chart uses the largest loans are in the sectors of agriculture, livestock
building greenhouses and services. Investments made by financial Unions have had a positive impact
on the Albanian economy causing production to grow by 70%, livestock production by 21% and 10%
harvest.
In Albania remains much more to do because it is a country that has a negative trade balance and
most of the goods imported. It is the duty of the Albanian government to implement legislation so that
the product be more competitive domestic and affect the growth of exports.
To improve access to microcredit for micro-credit, diversification beyond focusing only on banks as
a source of credit. This includes solving policy problems in the area of securities and capital controls.
-29-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
For the contribution of this institution in rural microfinance and its impact on social and economic
terms, it is valued and prestigious international institutions. An assessment is made of the global
platform MIX Microfinance, the Union has classified the 20 best institutions for the years 2008 and
2007. As for 2009, is the platform MIX ASC Union was honored with the Silver Award for
Transparency and reporting social Indicators.
Union SCA Group Profile: Union Group SCA is an institution that has its beginnings in 1992. The
Union is a voluntary union of Savings and Credit Associations, which provide cohesion and solidarity
at the national level. Local SCA members and their clients are the basis of the activity of the group.
Being in the heart of the village, SCAs are committed to meeting the needs of residents of rural
financial services. Control over the management of SCA performed through 40.432 members, who
choose boards during the Annual General Assemblies. About 850 volunteers chosen represent members
being engaged together with the staff of the Union of responsibly managing the SCA. By focusing on a
broad target group living in rural areas, GROUP SCA Union has as its members and clients farmers,
artisans, merchants, etc., who have equal rights in decision-making institution.
Fundamental principles Union Group – SCA: Basic principles Union-SCA Group guided by the
philosophy of financial cooperatives.
Financial cooperatives created and administered by their own members who belong to the rural
community in a specific geographic area and who aspire to promote activities and improve their
livelihoods.
Union Group SCA is strongly supported Savings and Credit Societies, which are financial
cooperative type structures operating in the heart of the village. Model underlying Union Group SCA
stay trust, solidarity, transparency and volunteering. Social pressure to exercise Savings and Credit
-30-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Society members to other members provide security and guarantee the performance of financial
services offered by the Savings and Credit Societies.
Union Group - SCA has in its structure 40.432 members, who elect and be elected to the governing
structures of the SCA and the Union. Members of Savings and Credit Associations makers themselves.
The General Assembly is the highest decision making body, which selects and other governing bodies
periodically.
Mission Union-SCA GROUP is to provide financial services to members of the SCA, residents of rural
areas, in order to promote productive activities, improving living standards and continuous
development of rural area.
-31-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ASC UNION
GENERAL ASSEMBLY
EXECUTIVE
DIRECTOR
Figure 3: The organization of work, relationship Union-SCA- based on the principles of cooperative financial
ASC Union credit applies a methodology based on group and individual. At the core of our
methodology is lending through savings and credit society. So, for an individual to apply or get a loan
-32-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
should become or be a member of a group of licensed and specifically, a member of a Joint Savings
and Loans. So, our methodology is based on the principles of operation of Financial Cooperative.
Figure 4: Graph the progress of key parameters
5. CONCLUSIONS
-33-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
6. REFERENCES
(GARP), G. A. o. R. P., n.d. CREDIT RISK MANAGEMENT. s.l.:s.n.
Chijoriga, M. a. C., 1999. "Micro Enterprise Financing: Is there a Best model?". s.l.:s.n.
Cook, P. &. N. F., n.d. Finance and Small and Medium-Sized Enterprise Development.. Journal of Developmental
EnterpreneursInp,, Volume 6 (I) April.
Daniels, L. a. N. A., 1993. "Results of a Nation-wide Survey on Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises in Malawi".
s.l.:s.n.
Grade, O. T., 1984. "The role of Rural Credit Projects in Reaching the Poor, IFAD's Experience" in ILO. Group
Based Savings and Credit for the Rural Poor, Geneva. s.l.:s.n.
Green, C. J. P. K. R. M. a. V. M., 2002. "How do Small Firms in Developing Countries Raise Capital? Evidence
from Large-Scale Survey of Kenyan Micro and Small Scale Enterprises". s.l.:s.n.
Hossain, M., 1988. "Credit for the Alleviation of Rural Poverty: The Grameen Bank in Bangladesh". s.l.:s.n.
Zeller, M., n.d. "Rural Finance Institutions and Systems-Models of Rural Financial Institution". s.l.:s.n.
KCS lending regulations Member Savings and Credit
Newsletters, annual reports 2005-2013 (Albanian Savings and Credit Union)
Annual Reports of the Bank of Albania
-34-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Corporate Governance has been a major concern and a focal point of attention for practitioners, academics, and
policy makers around world during the last two decades. The recent financial crisis, has rekindled the discussion
on the importance of corporate governance, as a way of preventing risky behaviours from corporations, banks, and
financial institutions, around the world, and especially the European Union and the Eastern Europe.
The aim of this paper is to present the current developments and status of the corporate governance’s legal and
institutional framework in the countries of the Black Sea region. Research on international corporate governance
systems, and comparative analysis of national frameworks, provide more insights and understanding to the
specifics of corporate governance across countries and helps identify the ways in which it affects the conduct of
international business and investment, and the challenges needed to be faced within the near future, especially in
times of financial and economic distress and uncertainty. These issues become more important for emerging
economies and economies in transition as sound corporate governance frameworks are considered to be a source of
multiple benefits both for corporations and the economy at large, by enhancing transparency and attracting
investors.
The countries of the Black Sea Region that will be examined are Armenia, Azerbaijan, Bulgaria, Georgia,
Moldavia, Romania, Russia, Turkey and Ukraine, along with Albania, Greece and Serbia. A literature review of
the research on the corporate governance framework of each country is conducted, with two-fold purpose. The first
is to examine the effect corporate governance mechanisms and systems have on the performance of firms across
the countries of the region, and to assess the effectiveness they have based on the specific characteristics of each
country. The second one is to examine the hypothesis of convergence between corporate governance systems in
the global economy, but now in a regional level. The importance of reporting corporate governance indices and
disclosure will also be demonstrated. The paper concludes by identifying issues that should be investigated in
further detail.
KEYWORDS
Corporate Governance, Convergence, Legal Systems, Black Sea Region.
1. INTRODUCTION
Corporate governance during the last 20 years has moved from being a research issue for academics to
an applied field of practice for policy makers and practitioners around the world. The economic and
financial globalization is magnifying the classical agency problem introduced by Jensen and Meckling
(1976), as allocation of capital has become more complex and investment choices have been multiplied
and amplified with the opening up and liberalization of financial and real markets. The financial crises
of the late 90s’ in Russia, Asia, Brazil, and especially the one in East Asia and South Korea in 1997,
made clear to everyone that the operation and the governance of the corporate sector affects not only
countries’ economies but also national and regional economies.
The recent financial crisis has made that even more obvious, as deficiencies in corporate
governance in the financial sector endangered not the regional but the global financial stability.
Research has pointed out furthermore the importance of corporate governance for firms and its impact
to national economies and growth especially during times of crises. While weak corporate governance
-35-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
has worsened stock market decline during the 1997 East Asian crisis (Johnson et al., 2000), during the
recent financial crisis, firms that had better corporate governance mechanisms managed to attain higher
rates of return (Cornett et al., 2009). This positive impact is also present to countries and national
economies. De Nicolo et al. (2008) reports the positive impact, improvements in corporate governance
quality have on macroeconomic variables that reflect real economic activity such as GDP growth,
productivity growth, and the ratio of investment to GDP, as better corporate governance can add value
by improving firm performance, through more efficient management, better asset allocation, better
labour policies, and other efficiency improvements.
Kirkpatrick (2009) identified failures and weaknesses in corporate governance arrangements as a
crucial factor that should be attributed for the crisis of the global financial system in 2007 and 2008.
Corporate governance failures at major financial institutions in the US and banks in Europe,
contributed not only to a global financial and corporate turmoil but also to triggering subsequent
countries recessions, the aftermath of whom is still present especially for Greece.
These results have reasonably drawn attention on the issue by the corporate world and policymakers
as the potential macroeconomic, distributional and long-term consequences of a strong corporate
governance system have been acknowledged, and became a central point of discussion and planning.
As expected a large and continuingly growing body of research has over the last two decades examined
and documented the importance of legal, cultural, and institutional foundations of the corporate
governance framework of countries and the effect it has on the quality of the corporate governance and
economic development. However, evidence for these links between law and economics, highlighting
the roles of legal foundations and well-defined property rights have been provided mainly for
developed western countries with properly functioning market economies. Emerging markets has been
in the epicentre of research on this field only recently. The importance of Corporate Governance has
been even more important for transition economies (Peters et al., 2011), like the ones of the Black Sea
Region, as these countries did not have long established financial institution infrastructures to face
agency problems related with the financing and management of corporations (McGee, 2009).
The purpose of this paper is to examine and review the literature concerning the legal and
institutional framework of corporate governance and its mechanisms and the effect it has on
corporations, in the Black Sea Region. The countries that will be examined are Armenia, Azerbaijan,
Bulgaria, Georgia, Moldavia, Romania, Russia, Turkey and Ukraine, along with Albania, Greece and
Serbia.
The rest of the paper is structured as follows. In the section to come a review on the definitions of
corporate governance is offered and the way it benefits corporations and economies. In the third section
the legal and institutional framework situation in the Black Sea Region is analysed, followed by the
examination of major corporate governance mechanisms for corporations. In the fifth section the
convergence hypothesis of the corporate governance systems across the world and the Black Sea
Region is assessed, and finally the paper concludes with proposals for further research.
This definition can be expanded to define corporate governance as being concerned with the
resolution of collective action problems among dispersed investors and the reconciliation of conflicts of
interest between all possible corporate claimholders (Claessens and Yurtoglu, 2013).
-36-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Zingales (1998) broadens the above definition describing corporate governance system as “the
complex set of constraints that shape the ex post bargaining over the quasi rents generated by the
firm”, including all stakeholders, that can be creditors, other corporations, financial markets,
institutions, employees, society, and special interests groups. Relationships with stakeholders are very
important as they are input factors without which the firm cannot operate.
Claessens and Yurtoglu, (2013) identified 5 different ways that corporate governance affects both
firms’ performance and counties’ economies in general.
Given the importance of the improvements Corporate Governance can bring to corporations,
organizations and countries, it has received considerable attention form institutions and legal
authorities across the world, with an increasing number of texts, studies, research and guidelines
to be added every year in continuously growing literature. However the most influential text that is
used as the standard for measuring the quality of corporate governance mechanisms and framework is
the OECD Principles on Corporate Governance (OECD, 2004) that identifies six categories of actions
that should be considered:
These principles have served as a basis for a continuing dialogue and evolution of corporate
governance framework for both OECD and non OECD countries (Jesover and Kirkpatrick, 2005;
McGee, 2009), but also as a framework of evaluating and comparing corporate governance systems
across different countries. In the following section the application of these principles in the Black Sea
Region countries is examined.
Table 1. Macroeconomics and Financial indicators of the Black Sea Region Countries (2010-2013)
GDP per GDP Trade FDI Market Listed Stock Stock
Country
Capita Growth (%GDP) inflows Capitalization Companies Traded Traded
-37-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Which are the institutional dimensions that matter for corporate governance and financial markets
development in general? Cross country analysis of corporate governance frameworks, includes the
investigation of whether the framework extends to rules that are mostly applied to or to institutions. La
Porta et al. (1998, 1999, 2000) with their influential research defined an analytical and concise
framework for comparative research on corporate governance by introducing an integrated approach to
law and legal institutions as well as financial institutions and markets. The development of a country's
corporation and financial markets, relates to these institutional characteristics and these characteristics
can directly and indirectly affect the growth and the prosperity of organizations and of the economy in
general. This is true for both periods of growth and periods of resseccion. During the 1997 East Asian
crisis, Johnshon et al. (2000) using country-level data, found out that weak legal institutions for
corporate governance were key factors in aggravating the stock market declines.
That is a serious issue as emerging markets and transitional economies tend to display weaker
measures of corporate governance, protection of property rights of investors and minority shareholders
(Peters et al. 2011). Beck et al. (2000) documented how the quality of a country's legal system not only
influences its financial development but also the direct effect it has on its economic and corporate
growth. Improvement in corporate governance may help a country with high level of corruption to
partially deal with the negative impacts of corruption in attracting capital, creating a momentum for
further improvement in both corporate governance and the governance of the public sector (Wu, 2005)
Chen et al. (2011) found that firm-level corporate governance significantly lowers the cost of equity
capital in 17 emerging markets.
The following Tables provide data and evidence on the strength of the legal systems in the region.
The less powerful enforcement mechanisms which predictably exist in emerging economies can
explain the weak enforcement of Corporate Governance codes and the low level of protection of the
rights of creditors and shareholders. The legal system are classified by its origin to Common Law
(British) or Civil Law (French, German, or Scandinavian). Almost all countries of the region have
implemented the Civil Law legal system and the most specifically its French or German variation.
The World Bank has published a series of reports on corporate governance as part of its project on
the Reports on the Observance of Standards and Codes (ROSC). The main components that constitute
the characteristics of the legal framework and the principles of corporate governance are summarised in
Table 2. These corporate governance principles in its ROSC are benchmarked against the OECD’s
Principles of Corporate Governance (OECD 2004) and are summarized by McGee (2009) with
Romania achieving the higher score to overall corporate governance performance compared to the rest
(for all columns 10 is the highest and best value that can be achieved). As far as Russia and Turkey are
concerned no data were provided. Romania and Bulgaria score higher in all categories of legal rights
protection as expected due to their participation in the EU, while Azerbaijan has the lowest scores in
every category.
Table 2. Strength of minority investor protection in the Black Sea Region Countries
The strength of protection of minority shareholders’ rights is a central issue in examining the
corporate legal framework of a country. Better creditor and shareholder rights are associated with
deeper and more developed financial markets, and also lower levels of cost capital. La Porta et al.
(1998) argue that greater investor protection increases investors’ willingness to provide financing and
will therefore enhance firms’ access to external finance. This relationship holds across countries and
over time, in that countries that improved their creditor rights saw an increase in financial development
(Djankov et al., 2008). In Table 3 the strength of the minority investor protection for 2014 as measured
by World Bank group and the Doing Business Organisation.
Table 3. Strength of minority investor protection in the Black Sea Region Countries
Strengt
Conflicts Strength h of
Direct Sharehold
Ease of of of Corporate minorit
Disclosu or Sharehold er
Country sharehold interests Governan Transparen y
re Liabili ers Rights Governan
ers suits regulatio ce cy investor
ty ce
ns Structures protecti
on
Armenia 5.0 6.0 8.0 6.3 10.5 3.0 3.5 5.7 6.0
Azerbaij 7.0 5.0 8.0 6.7 7.0 3.0 5.5 5.2 5.9
an
Bulgaria 10.0 2.0 7.0 6.3 7.5 6.0 8.5 7.3 6.8
Georgia 9.0 6.0 7.0 7.3 7.5 3.0 4.0 4.8 6.1
Moldavi 7.0 4.0 8.0 6.3 6.0 4.5 5.5 5.3 5.8
a
Romania 9.0 5.0 5.0 6.3 10.5 2.5 5.0 6.0 6.2
Russia 6.0 2.0 7.0 5.0 7.5 3.0 5.0 5.2 5.1
Turkey 9.0 5.0 7.0 7.0 10.0 4.5 6.0 6.8 6.9
Ukraine 4.0 2.0 6.0 4.0 7.0 3.0 7.0 5.7 4.8
Albania 7.0 8.0 7.0 7.3 7.5 7.0 7.0 7.2 7.3
Greece 7.0 4.0 5.0 5.3 7.5 6.0 5.0 6.2 5.8
Serbia 7.0 6.0 4.0 5.7 10.0 8.0 3.0 7.0 6.3
Source: World Bank - Doing Business.org .
Albania has made the greatest progress in this field, followed by Turkey and Bulgaria. Overall as
literature points out actual corporate governance quality in most countries has overall improved (De
Nicolo et al. 2008) as a result of the ongoing financial and economic globalisation, as it is also obvious
for the countries of the Black Sea Region. This improvement has also been the result of ongoing legal
reforms and practices across the region. Many of these changes have occurred in the aftermath and as a
response to crises, and some reforms have been major, while others were more partial and changed
only a few specific aspects.
The Bulgarian Securities Law in 2002 which provided protection against dilutive offerings and
freeze-outs. Atanasov et al. (2006) document that following the change, share prices jumped for firms
at high risk of tunnelling, relative to a low-risk control group. Minority shareholders participated
equally in secondary equity offers. Mandatory legislation concerning Corporate Governance was
introduced in 2002 in Greece (Law 3016/2002) and along with its amendments comprises the basis on
which listed and state owned companies operate, and are governed (Antoniadis and Ananikas, 2005;
Lazarides., 2010; Neratzidis and Filos., 2014). The main elements of the Greek legal system concern
the composition of the Board of Directors and the participation of non-executive directors, the
formation of committees, and the disclosure of information to investors. Further legislative acts were
passed in order to embody European legislative directives (Law 3693/2008, 3884/2010) and to specify
the governance of state owned enterprises (Neratzidis & Filos, 2014).
-39-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Disclosure of information is also a serious issue for the region despite the legal framework in place.
Albu and Girbina (2015) point out the reluctance of Romanian listed companies to provide information
concerning transactions of members of the board and of insiders.
-40-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
and ROE, increase as the number of directors on the board decreases, and that there is no significant
relation between proportion of independent directors on the board and bank performance.
Some Russian companies have adopted two-tiered boards, a practice likely borrowed from France
or Germany, and also the separation of roles between CEO and the Chairman of the Board was
introduced (McCarthy and Puffer, 2002), but this separation does not look to increase the value of the
firm nor its performance (Antoniadis and Ananikas, 2005), and the same evidence exists for boards of
Directors in Ukraine (Zheka., 2006).
-41-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Enterprises (SEV) and the Hellenic Association of Investors & Internet (Neratzidis and Filos, 2014). In
2012 the Hellenic Corporate Governance Council was formed in order to encourage the adoption of
good practices, and issued a new and updated set of voluntary codes in 2013. The voluntary or
“comply-or-explain” principle by Romanian listed companies was examined by Albu and Girbina
(2015). The findings of their research indicate a modest (although increasing) percentage of Romanian
listed companies that disclose the level of corporate governance compliance to voluntary codes and
also trace issues in disclosing this information in English.
6. CONCLUSION
The development of a stable and sound corporate governance system could greatly benefit the
Black Sea Region as it would lead to improved collaboration and cross-investments (Claessens &
Yurtoglu, 2013). An improvement of corporate governance practices in emerging markets could be
especially beneficial both to national minority shareholders, and western investors, but could also help
attracting new investors (Peters et al., 2011). The importance of the development of regional economies
and emerging markets with transparency and good governance practices, as a factor of regional and
global stability can be vividly demonstrated in the Black Sea Region. Studying the corporate
governance framework of the countries of the region and encouraging convergence between them
could help strengthen existing ties or even heal problematic relations.
The reforms in both obligatory legal frameworks and voluntary corporate governance practices
have led to an overall improvement of governance quality in most countries of the region, although in
varying degrees. As far as the research in the topic for the Black Sea region, is concerned attention
must be drawn in the lack of academic work for economies like Albania, Serbia, Armenia, and
Azerbaijan, while there is a growing bibliography for the most developed countries of the region
namely Russia, Ukraine, Turkey, Greece Romania and Bulgaria.
Further research through a comparative corporate governance approach should focus in three
directions:
• The further systematization and in depth classification of the corporate governance
practices of the countries in the region.
• The development of a framework and an index that would measure implementation and
compliance of the OECD principles of Corporate Governance in the region, and,
• The impact that corporate governance has in the macroeconomic status of the countries in
the region.
REFERENCES
Albu C.N., Gîrbina M.M., 2015., Compliance with corporate governance codes in emerging economies. How do
Romanian listed companies “comply-or-explain”?, Corporate Governance, Vol. 15, Iss. 1, pp. 85 – 107.
Alexandridis A., Antoniadis I., 2013., Export performance and intra-industry trade of the Economies of the Black
Sea Region., Journal of European Economy., Vol.12 (3), pp 296-308.
Antoniadis I., Ananikas L., 2005., Separating the roles of CEO and Chairman of the Board. The case of the Greek
listed firms. In Accounting and Finance in Transition Volume 2, eds. Chatzoglou P & Cevic Z. Greenwich UK,
pp. 225-237
Ararat, M. Ugur, M., 2003., Corporate governance in Turkey: an overview and some policy recommendations.,
Corporate Governance: The international journal of business in society, Vol. 3 Iss: 1, pp.58 - 75
Ararat, M., H. Orbay, 2006., Corporate Governance in Turkey; Implications for Investments and Growth.,
Available at SSRN: http://ssrn.com/abstract=2375767
Ararat, M., H. Orbay, and B. B. Yurtoglu. 2011. “The Effects of Board Independence in Controlled Firms:
Evidence from Turkey.” Working Paper. http://papers.ssrn.com/abstract=1663403 .
Arsoy A.P., Crowther D., 2008., Corporate governance in Turkey: reform and convergence., Social Responsibility
Journal, Vol. 4, Iss. 3 pp. 407 - 421
Atanasov, V., Black, B., Ciccotello, C.S., Gyoshev, S.B., 2006. How does law affect finance? An empirical
examination of tunneling in an emerging market. ECGI — Finance Working Paper No. 123/2006.
Beck, T., Levine, R., Loayza, N., 2000. Finance and the sources of growth. Journal of Financial Economics 58,
261–300.
-42-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Bruno, V.G., Claessens, S., 2010. Economic aspects of corporate governance and regulation. In: Baker, H.K.,
Anderson, R. (Eds.), Corporate Governance: A Synthesis of Theory, Research and Practice. John Wiley &
Sons, Hoboken, New Jersey, 599–619 (Robert W. Kolb Series in Finance).
Cadbury Committee, 1992., The Report of the Committee on the Financial Aspects of Corporate Governance., Gee
and Co. Ltd., London.
Chen, K.C.W., Chen, Z., Wei, K.C.J., 2011. Agency costs of free cash flows and the effect of shareholder rights
on the implied cost of capital. Journal of Financial and Quantitative Analysis, Vol. 46, pp. 171–207.
Claessens, S., Ueda, K., Yafeh, Y., 2010. Financial frictions, investment, and institutions. CEPR Discussion Paper
No. DP 8170
Claessens, S., Yurtoglou B.B., 2013. Corporate governance in emerging markets: A survey., Emerging Markets
Review, 15, 1-33.
Cornett, M.M., McNutt, J.J., Tehranian, H., 2009. The financial crisis, internal corporate governance, and the
performance of publicly-traded U.S. bank holding companies., Available at SSRN:
http://ssrn.com/abstract=1476969.
De Nicolo, G., Laeven, L., Ueda, K., 2008. Corporate governance quality: trends and real effects. Journal of
Financial Intermediation, Vol. 17, pp. 198–228.
Djankov, S., Lopez-de-Silanes, F., Porta, R.L., Shleifer, A., 2008b. The law and economics of self-dealing.
Journal of Financial Economics, Vol. 88, pp. 430–465.
Durnev, A., Kim, E.H., 2005. To steal or not to steal: firm attributes, legal environment, and valuation. Journal of
Finance, Vol. 60, pp. 1461–1493.
Estrin S., Rosevear A., 1999. Enterprise performance and ownership: The case of Ukraine., European Economic
Review, Vol. 43, pp. 1125-1136.
Estrin S., Wright M., 1999. Corporate Governance in the Former Soviet Union: An Overview., Journal of
Comparative Economics, Vol. 27, pp. 398–421
.
Estrin, S., 2002. Competition and corporate governance in transition. The Journal of Economic Perspectives, Vol.
16, pp. 101–124.
Gilson, R.J., 2001. Globalizing corporate governance: convergence of form or function. The American Journal of
Comparative Law, Vol. 49, pp. 329–357.
Jesover F., Kirkpatrick., G., 2005., The revised OECD principles of Corporate Governance and their relevance to
non-OECD countries., Corporate Governance : An International Review., Vol. 13 No.2, pp. 127-136.
Johnson, S., Boone, P., Breach, A., Friedman, E., 2000. Corporate governance in the Asian financial crisis.
Journal of Financial Economics, Vol. 58, pp. 141–186.
Jensen, M., and Meckling, W. 1976., Theory of the firm: Managerial behavior, agency costs, and ownership
structure, Journal of Financial Economics, Vol.3, pp. 305-360.
Khanna, T., Kogan, J., Palepu, K.G., 2006. Globalization and similarities in corporate governance: a cross-country
analysis. The Review of Economics and Statistics, Vol.88, pp. 69–90.
Kirkpatrick G., 2009 The Corporate Governance Lessons from the Financial Crisis., Financial Markets Trends,
Vol. 2009 Iss.1, pp. 61-87.
Kose, A., Prasad, E., Rogoff, K., Wei, S.-J., 2010. Financial globalization and economic policies. CEPR
Discussion Papers 7117 (C.E.P.R. Discussion Papers).
Kostyuk A., Koverga V., 2007., Corporate Governance in Ukraine: The role of ownership structures., Corporate
Ownership and Control Journal, at
http://www.virtusinterpress.org/IMG/pdf/5_CORPORATE_OWNERSHIP.pdf
La Porta, R., Lopez-De-Silanes, F., Shleifer, A., 1999. Corporate ownership around the world., Journal of
Finance., 54, pp. 471–517.
La Porta, R., Lopez-de-Silanes, F., Shleifer, A., Vishny, R., 1998. Law and finance., Journal of Political
Economy, Vol. 106, pp. 1113–1155.
La Porta, R., Lopez-de-Silanes, F., Shleifer, A., Vishny, R.W., 2000. Investor protection and corporate
governance. Journal of Financial Economics, Vol. 58, pp. 3–29.
Lazareva O., Rachinsky A. and Stepanov S., 2008., Corporate Governance, Ownership Structures and Investment
in Transition Economies: The Case of Russia, Ukraine and Kyrgyzstan., Available at SSRN:
http://papers.ssrn.com/sol3/papers.cfm?abstract_id=1102610
Lazarides, T., 2010., Corporate governance law effect in Greece., Journal of Financial Regulation and
Compliance, Vol. 18 No. 4, pp. 370-385.
Li. J., Harisson J.R., 2008., Corporate governance and national culture: a multi-country study., Corporate
Governance: The international journal of business in society, Vol. 8 Iss: 5, pp.607 - 621
McCarthy D., Puffer S., 2002. Corporate Governance in Russia:
Towards a European, US, or Russian Model?,
European Management Journal Vol. 20, No. 6, pp. 630–640.
McGee R.W., 2009., Ch.44 Summary and analysis of countries studies., in Corporate Governance in Transition
Economies., ed. McGee R.W., pp. 402-421.
-43-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
McGee R.W., Bose S., 2009., Corporate governance in transition economies: a comparative study of Armenia,
Azerbaijan and Georgia, International Journal of Economic Policy in Emerging Economies., Vol. 2, (3) pp.
228-240.
Monks., R.A.G., Minnow., N., 2011., Corporate Governance., Willey, New York.
Nerantzidis M., Filos J., 2014., Recent corporate governance developments in Greece., Corporate Governance:
The international journal of business in society, Vol. 14 (3) pp. 281-299.
OECD., 2004., OECD Principles of Corporate Governance. Available at:
http://www.oecd.org/dataoecd/32/18/31557724.pdf .
Orbay, H., Yurtoglu, B.B., 2006. The impact of corporate governance structures on the corporate investment
performance in Turkey. Corporate Governance: An International Review., Vol. 14, pp. 349–363.
Peters S., Miller M., Kusyk S., 2011., How relevant is corporate governance and corporate social responsibility in
emerging markets?, Corporate Governance: The international journal of business in society, Vol. 11 (4) pp.
429-445.
Rajan, R.G., Zingales, L., 1998. Financial dependence and growth. American Economic Review, Vol.88, pp.559–
586.
Shleifer A., and Vishny. R.W., 1997., A Survey of corporate governance., The Journal of Finance., Vol.52 No.2,
pp. 737-783.
Spanos, L.J., 2005, Corporate governance in Greece: developments and policy implications., Corporate
Governance: The international journal of business in society, Vol. 5 (1), pp.15 – 30.
Stančić, P., Čupić, M., Barjaktarović-Rakočević, S., & Benković, S., 2012., Dominant shareholders, board
structure and bank performance: Evidence from Serbia. Industrija, Vol. (2), pp. 51-68.
World Bank., 2015., Doing Business., available at www.doingbusiness.org.
World Bank., 2015., World Development Indicators., available at http://data.worldbank.org/data-catalog/world-
development-indicators.
World Bank., Reports on the Observance of Standards and Codes (ROSC) – Corporate Governance. Country
Reports. Available at : http://www.worldbank.org/ifa/rosc_cg.html.
Wu Xun., 2005., Corporate Governance and Corruption: A Cross-Country Analysis. Governance: An International
Journal of Policy, Administration, and Institutions, Vol. 18 (2), pp. 151–170.
Yoshikawa, T., Rasheed, A., 2009. Convergence of corporate governance: critical review and future directions.
Corporate Governance: An International Review., Vol. 17, pp. 388–404.
Zheka, V., 2006., Does corporate governance causally predict firm performance? Panel data and instrumental
variables evidence., CERT Discussion Paper No. DP06/05. Available at SSRN:
http://ssrn.com/abstract=877913.
Zingales, L., 1998., Corporate Governance., The New Palgrave Dictionary of Economics and Law., MacMillan,
London.
-44-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
In this paper, we attempt to define and investigate, in a new and radically different way, a class of goods which has
recently started to appear in the international economic literature: the so-called global public goods, i.e., goods that
do not offer competitive advantages to their individual country producer, despite their fundamental necessity. The
novelty and exclusivity of our approach regarding this category of goods, and the new name that we will attempt
to establish for them, will tentatively allow us to draw some unpleasant conclusions about the prospect of
producing these absolutely necessary public goods.
KEYWORDS
1. INTRODUCTION
How do we define a public good? There are several ways to approach. Let's look at the most basic: 1)
From Samuelson (1954) and on we define a public good as one a) which is not competitive in
consumption, i.e., when someone uses it, this does not exclude any other to use it as well, b) it is not
possible (or cost effective) to exclude someone from its consumption, i.e., it is impossible, difficult or
expensive to impose a price on each of us for the consumption of the public good. There are finer
distinctions, but reporting them here will not add anything to the argument we want to emphasize. And
this is that, clearly, the definition of a commodity as a public good depends on whether or not it its
demand is expected to be materialized in the market. For these goods which, although desirable and /or
necessary, no demand is expected (although the resources for their production are not available), the
term “public goods” is reserved. Regardless of how we define a public good, economic theory states
that the provision of it (not necessarily also the production - and in recent years less so) is publicly
undertaken by funding its cost. There is no question, at least in theory: the State, after diagnosing the
necessity or even just the desirability of providing the public good will seek to fulfill this claim.
Otherwise, if left to market forces, the theory states that the desired and / or required public good will
not be produced at all (or will produced in smaller quantities). But why the State will be forced to
comply and / or arrange by its own will to provide the public good? Usually the above question does
not arise, at least at the university / academic level. Before we answer this question we will proceed
with a new definition.
-45-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
blocking opportunities for all citizens on earth (in contrast to what happens with the classic public
goods which are limited within the state boundaries). By adding one more criterion and, remaining
within the limits of the approach of Samuelson from the demand side, we define global public goods as
those for which (under normal conditions), while necessary, market demand will not manifest. The
only differentiation between public and global public goods then, is limited to their spatial dimension:
the use of simple public goods is limited within the boundaries of one State, whereas the use of global
public goods lies outside these limits and, possibly, refers to the entire planet. There are many goods
that can be placed under the above definition. In our text we will be confined to a very significant
subgroup thereof: ecological global public goods (to mention probably the most important which is
tackling global warming). This new approach has begun, though still at an embryonic level, to find its
place in the teaching of public economics and in the international literature (Kaul et. al. 1999). It
continues on the well-known line of simple public goods, suggesting to the international community to
undertake the provision of global public goods – surely recognizing a higher degree of difficulty (due
to the global scale of the problem), but nothing more. Sooner than later in view of the critical
importance of providing global public goods, proponents of this concept hope that their global supply
follows, on the steps of the preceding national paradigm. We believe that this approach, although
useful, by following the paradigm of Samuelson step by step, leads to major bottlenecks. Let's see
which and why.
ecosystem of the Amazon intact, it will have a number of positive effects on the biosphere, biodiversity
etc. globally, while at the same time the benefits will diffuse worldwide, without excluding possibilities
or imposing a price to other states. Still so, the emphasis in the definition is placed on the demand side
- the only difference being the scope of consumption (whether local-national or global). Our approach
does not intend to contest these criteria, but by putting the central question of why a State wishes or is
forced to produce public goods, introduces the production / supply side (and not just the consumption
or demand one) of public goods in the discussion and therefore re-conceptualizes them. Let's see how:
There are several answers to the above question on why we produce public goods. Initially, we will
restrict ourselves to the classic public goods and then we will talk about ecumenical or universal goods.
For the classical public goods, the state producing them:
1) can meet the dictates of scientists, especially economists who, foreseeing an obvious gap in how the
system of free private markets work, advise its coverage and then the state responds by arranging to
provide the goods (in the sense of "benevolent ruler"). This could be characterized as the preferred
explanation in academic literature, which as we all know, is catalytically dominated by neoclassical
theory and its various versions.
2) Also the state can, though perhaps not moving from the charitable motives of the previous case,
provide the classical public goods through the competitive electoral process, i.e., trying to satisfy its
electoral clientele which understands that based exclusively on private plans these goods will not be
produced (although desirable), and thus supports a provider - party with votes. This party provides
them4, fearing that if it does not comply with the voters will someone else will do (winning the election
and consenting).
3) Thirdly, and crucially for our argument, even if the State is not benevolent, even if for any reason
the citizens themselves do not realize the benefits from the provision of public goods, and so do not
require nor consent to their provision, the State may provide public goods due to the existence of the
competitive interstate system. We want to stress this reason, because we believe that it is of primary
importance, for the provision of public goods in the real world (as opposed to the abstract world of
theory), above and beyond the other two reasons. Of course, the second reason exerts considerable
influence, while in our opinion the first has a lesser (even minimal) effect. The competitive interstate
system by nature exerts enormous pressure on States to respond in different ways, if they do not wish
to suffer losses in the hierarchical position within the system, depend on other stronger states, be
endangered by territorial or population loss through wars, migration, brain drain, etc. The ruling elites
in each State are confronted with obvious risks if they fail to keep to a high competitive level. The risks
for these range from the loss of their hegemonic position within their State (in favor of another
competitive leadership-team more convincing that it has a more effective vision of national
supremacy), to their subordination into following other powerful elite groups (and therefore loss of
independence and relative power) and, finally, the very loss of sovereignty through war or becoming a
protectorate. Returning to the above primary reason on the provision of public goods (i.e. the existence
of a "benevolent ruler"), we emphasize that in principle we would not exclude it. We do not necessarily
think the people, and therefore their representatives, as exclusively selfish subjects, strictly “Homo
economicus” and / or worse, competitively authoritarian, violent, aggressive beings etc. But,
nevertheless, we will not hesitate to agree that the above mentioned reason (benevolent ruler) is rarely
sufficient by itself and, in any case, does not cover the provision of public goods overall. Only at the
margin left by the two other reasons, the electoral and the interstate competition5, it can provide public
goods, which are not restricted exclusively or predominantly in the interior, i.e. to offer ecumenical or
universal goods, based just on scientific knowledge and good intention (i.e. the first reason).
4
The idea of the competitive electoral process ,has been emphasized usually from political scientists since its
Sumpeter’s (1944) classic exposition.
5
That is if more than enough resources of the state suffice for both types of competition (intra and interstate, i.e.,
when in limited space and limited time a State feels strong enough and is not threatened by internal and / or mainly
international competition, which can happen only temporarily and only for the head State or coalition of States).
-47-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
-48-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
“anarchy” (Mearsheimer 2006), theories of “hegemony” and the neo-liberal theories of international
relations of the type of the “invisible hand”. Then, we will see how each of them is expected to address
the problem of ecumenical / universal goods. But, first, we will say a few words on the content of each
one, always keeping in mind that the presentation will be made only with an eye to ecumenical /
universal goods and not aspiring to a full-fledged presentation. We begin with the rather prevalent
realistic school of international anarchy: in this, competition between member-States is considered
inherent and nondeductible. The profit of one is the loss of the other. In such an international system of
zero-sum games, it is unlikely for a State to cooperate in providing universal goods, pretty much
relying on the logic of a free rider. In an inherently zero-sum world, my efforts to tackle global
warming will be undermined by indifference or exploitation by the neighbor, so it is unlikely that I will
initiate them at all. Even transnational agreements, when and if it were possible to conclude, without
commonly accepted auditing mechanisms and mainly without imposing substantial penalties for
offenders (particularly if they are strong), cannot work consistently and permanently to produce
ecumenical goods. The case of the Kyoto agreements is indicative in this regard (Clark, 2012, Stern
2013, World Bank 2012). Based on this theory, perhaps the only possible case of providing universal
goods would be if the international anarchic, competitive system ceased to exist and was replaced by a
system of “imperial” control, so as to mitigate the inherent undermining of the provision of universal
goods by competition or if the threat became so direct, active and pretty much equally serious for those
involved, resulting in voluntary and unconditional compliance. But regarding the ecological universal
goods this will not help anyway, sometimes because the threat is not evenly distributed (moreover
because it is not even certain how it will be distributed - except for borderline cases, e.g., small Pacific
islands sinking), sometimes because when its catastrophic effects become visibly, it will be too late6.
The phenomenon of universal weakness in the production of ecumenical goods is more difficult is to
examine using the two other theories. These are the various versions of theories of international
hegemony, which draw inspiration from the hegemonic stability theory and the risks of hegemonic
absence of C. Kindleberger (1973), which he used to explain the crisis of 1929. We briefly refer to
theories of G. Modelski (1987), E. Wallerstein (1974, 1980, 1989, 2011) theories of Worldsystems, the
American School of Social Structure of Accumulation (Gordon, 1982), the French School of
Regulation ( Aglietta1973), etc. All these theories perceive the existence of a world ruler who, within
an otherwise competitive international system, provides among others, some kind of supranational -
collective goods. In any case these goods, although by nature superstate, are included within the limits
of serving the hegemony, which is competing against the previous international hegemony that it
replaced and against its current and future competitors. The benefits of the Bretton Woods system
(monetary stability etc.) during the ascent phase of American hegemony is a typical example. It is very
difficult for the above theory, with its inherently competitive nature, within an internationally
competitive system, to encompass the provision of universal goods, which by nature are destined
almost for everyone. We conclude this section with the “invisible hand” strand of theories, such as that
of R.Kehoane (1984). Assuming the existence of common interests, as undoubtedly is the case of
universal goods, these theories consider how to overcome problems of cooperation among States. But,
by not perceiving the relations between nations as inherently competitive, these theories are unable to
respond to the realistic possibilities for cooperation in a context like that- which is probably closer to
reality than any other.
We see therefore that there is no satisfactory theory that convincingly leads to the production of
ecumenical goods. Let us return briefly to the distinction with the classic public goods.
6
“No nation will be immune to the impacts of climate change. However, the distribution of impacts is likely to be
inherently unequal and tilted against many of the world’s poorest regions”, World Bank (2012), Executive
Summary xiii.
-49-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
7
Which, of course, are not identified sa in the case of individuals, but is relatively easy to jump from them to the
individual’s selfishness, rather that transit from selfishness to selflessness.
8
Which can be subdivided into 12 sub-sections (Diamond 2006), 8 endemic in human society (deforestation and
habitat destruction, problems of soil –soil’s erosion - salinisation - loss of fertility, water management problems,
overhunting, overfishing, impact from imported species to native ones, increasing human population and increased
per capita impact of people) and four recent (anthropogenic climate change, accumulation of toxic chemicals in the
environment, energy deficit and full utilization of the Earth's photosynthetic capacity by men).
-50-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
accept the crucial role of all kinds of competition in the provision of all kinds of goods (private, semi-
private, with external economies or diseconomies, public in the strict sense and ecumenical / universal
goods), we are heading to apparent dead ends. Even though our awareness of the fact is very limited -
and unfortunately remains an acute paradox how the inherently individualistic and based on
competition neoclassical economics, rather than encouraging, prevents the awareness of the limits of
competition we do not know of another type to provide products, other than the competitive one. The
predominance of neoclassical economic thought, oddly enough, made it easier to hide the deep
competitive character of the provision of goods, not only for private or semi-private goods, but also for
public goods, by using (erroneously in our view), the expression “public goods” to refer to non-
privately offered competing goods, i.e., goods that can facilitate prevalence in competitive races
between parties or countries, thus setting a false distinction between competitively offered private
goods versus non-competitively publicly offered goods. Beyond the above useful but of secondary
importance distinction, we must draw a fundamental distinction between competitively offered goods,
with different but equally competitive procedures (markets - elections - interstate system) versus goods
which cannot be competitively offered. The first category includes pure private, semi–private (with
externalities) and also classic public goods which can bear a competitive advantage to their provides
and the second refers to ecumenical goods offering no possibilities of appropriation to their providers
as well as partial depletion of their scarce resources, therefore offering a more or less competitive
disadvantage to them.
7. CONCLUSION
The above analysis showed that, if we realistically pose the question of who and why provides non
private goods, we will discover a category of goods over the conventional / classic public ones which
cannot be produced competitively, as is the case for all other goods. We named them ecumenical /
universal non-competing goods. We argued that the classic Samuelsonian logic, which, even
embryonically, has begun to be used for global goods, leads to a lack of understanding in a very central
point: their underproduction or complete absence of production, globally. Obviously this is a very
crucial point: no matter how useful it is to understand the presence of global or universal public goods,
if the analysis does not inform us about their supply failures, rather leads to obfuscation. In view of the
critical importance of understanding the absence of production of such goods for the future of the
planet, it is time to take a position regarding a fundamental and extremely difficult to solve problem:
mankind must find ways to overcome the competitive provision of goods (either we refer to obviously
private goods, or to covertly public goods), if we are to respond to the ecological challenges of the
future and provide the indispensable ecumenical goods: nothing less and therefore nothing more than a
complete and universal shift of paradigm in understanding the operation of the intra-state and interstate
system. The task is gigantic, but such is also the magnitude of the problem.
REFERENCES
Aglietta, M., 1976. A Theory of Capitalist Regulation: The US Experience, Verso.
Carson R., 1962. Silent Spring, Houghton Mifflin.
Clark, D., 2012. “Has the Kyoto Protocol made any difference to carbon emissions?”
http://www.guardian.co.uk/environment/blog/2012/nov/26/kyoto-protocol-carbon-emissions
Gordon, D.M., Edwards, R., and Reich, M., 1982. Segmented Work, Divided Workers: The historical
transformation of labor in the United States, Cambridge University Press.
Hardin, G., 1968. "The Tragedy of the Commons". Science 162 (3859): 1243–1248.
Kaul I., Grunberg I., Stern M.A., 1999. Global public goods : international cooperation in the 21st
century, New York , Oxford University Press.
Keohane, R., 1984. After Hegemony: Cooperation and Discord in the World Political Economy,
Princeton University Press.
Kindleberger, C.P., 1973. The World in Depression: 1929-1939. University of California Press.
-51-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Meadows, D.H., Meadows, D.L., Randers J., and Behrens III William W., 1972. Limits to Growth,
New York: New American Library.
Mearsheimer, J., 2001. The Tragedy of Great Power Politics.
Mancur O.Jr., 1965. The Logic of Collective Action: Public Goods and the Theory of Groups, Harvard
University Press.
Modelski G., 1987. Long Cycles in World Politics. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1987.
Diamond, J., 2005. Collapse: How Societies Choose to Fail or Succeed. New York: Penguin Books.
Samuelson, P.A., 1954. "The Pure Theory of Public Expenditure". Review of Economics and Statistics
36 (4): 387–389.
Schneider S. H., Mesirow L.E., 1976. The Genesis Strategy: Climate and Global Survival, Plenum Pub
Corp.
Schumpeter, J.,1942. Capitalism, Socialism and Democracy.
Stern N., 2006. The Stern Review on the Economics of Climate Change,
http://www.webcitation.org/5nCeyEYJr, Executive Summary, p. 1
Stern N., 2013. “I Got it Wrong on Climate Change – It’s far, far worse”
http://www.guardian.co.uk/environment/2013/jan/27/nicholas-stern-climate-change-davos
Wallerstein E., 1989. The Modern World System Vol. I (1974), Vol. II (1980), Vol. III, Academic
Press and Vol. IV (2011), University of California Press.
World Bank, 2012. Tern Down the Heat, Why a 4 C Warmer World Must be Avoided. A report for the
World Bank by the Potsdam Institute for Climate Impact Research and Climate Analytics.
ANNEX.
Case Study: contrasting national or classic public goods with ecumenical / universal ones. The US
military spending (as well as the corresponding spending of other leading countries), in contrast to the
costs of combating global warming.
We will present an extreme example: a country, let us assume the USA, has a remarkable amount of
resources available and intends to use it for the provision of public goods: there are two options (we
take two extreme scenarios in order to highlight almost ideotypically and clearly the difference). The
first option refers to a classical public good: national security. The USA spent just under $ 700 billion
in 2010, a crisis year, to provide this public good, while world total military spending reached $ 1.5
trillion dollars. The second option relates to the production of an ecumenical / universal good: to limit
greenhouse gas emissions, thus mitigating the problem of global warming. According to the most
widely recognized worldwide study of N. Stern, the annual allocation of 1% of global GDP to remedy
the climate change, would be enough to avoid the catastrophic consequences in the mid to long term,
which can vary between 5 and 20% (!) of global GDP annually. The Stern study, argues that the failure
to take measures to avoid the greenhouse effect “is the greatest and widest-ranging market failure ever
seen, presenting a unique challenge for economics” (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ Stern Review). What
is the amount needed to avoid this greater global market failure over time? According to Stern, an
amount of around 1% of global GDP would suffice. Considering that the global GDP in the mid-2000s,
when the Stern report was drafted, was somewhere in the $ 60 trillion dollars area, an annual sum of
around 600 billion dollars could properly address this global problem and prevent future losses in the
order of $ 3 to 12 trillion annually. These figures, even in the above coarse approach, can adequately
highlight the problem. In the limit, the USA alone could offset the greenhouse effect (remember we are
referring to about 600 billion), by transferring the biggest part of its military resources to this cause,
downgrading its military budget at the level of the second military spender (China) - i.e., close to 100
billion (700-600 = 100). And do not think that this would be very dangerous for the USA. In
conjunction with its allies in NATO and SEATO, Saudi Arabia etc., their military budgets would again
exceed, at a scale of three or four to one, (theoretically) potential rivals such as Russia, China and Iran.
Of course this scenario sounds unrealistic. But, still, a cut of about 45% of the US military budget and
35% of all the others could achieve the same result. This setting obviously does not change the military
-52-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
balance worldwide in any way. But nobody dreamed to put the matter at hand on the global agenda,
even for a first approach / discussion. Let us return to the classical non-comparative individualistic
calculations of economics. As we mentioned, the 90% reduction in USA military spending would
suffice to reverse global warming and would avert future losses between $ 3 and 12 trillion per year
worldwide: as the USA produces a percentage between 20 and 25% of it, it could gain a sum ranging
from $ 600 (3 trillion * 0.2) billion to $ 3 trillion (12 trillion * 0.25)! This is a classic Pareto optimal
intervention, spending a certain amount otherwise (i.e., redistributing a certain amount of resources)
along the curve of the productive potential of the economy, would result in acquiring an additional
benefit of up to 500%!
-53-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Purpose: The present research has been inspired by the growing international interest in and recognition of the
concept of Social Capital as an important factor and building block for the confrontation of the economic and
social consequences of crises. The growing importance of social capital at the national level prompted the
undertaking of its measurement, in order for this research to become a guide for further investigation and mapping
of the existing dynamics in Greek society.
Methodology- design of the research: The literature review outlines the presence of social capital in Greece, the
social research already undertaken on the subject, its special characteristics and its conclusions. The measurement
of the social capital was carried out with the use of a questionnaire, which was based on the most dynamic
dimensions of the concept found in international literature, in order to select and phrase the appropriate questions.
The research was conducted in the region of Eastern Thessaly and more specifically in the city of Volos and the
semi- urban and rural areas of the municipalities of Volos and Agia. We focused on the dimensions of general
trust, the participation in informal networks, the political participation and the confidence in society and its
institutions.
Findings: The results revealed low levels of general trust and specific trust in the civil society and its institutions,
while we also found relatively high levels of participation in informal networks and satisfactory levels of political
participation These results confirm the respective results of previous similar studies while we also record the
differences in the social capital stock among the residents of urban and rural areas as well as by gender.
Conclusions- recommendations: The mistrust and the negative attitudes in filling the questionnaires, in
combination with the conclusions drawn from them, lead to the need to measure more aspects of the social capital.
A wider research, at the national or regional level may add new dimensions such as participations in official
networks and or social tolerance and behavior. The present research brings up to date the results of earlier work
and contributes in a measurable way, to the reorientation of the goals and methods for the application of the
necessary social and economic reforms.
KEYWORDS
Social capital, trust, participation, society, institutions, economic crisis.
1. INTRODUCTION
Social Capital is a relatively new concept in Social Sciences. Nevertheless, in a relatively short period
of time, international literature (Fukuyama, 1995, Stieglitz et al.,, 2009 and others) has focused on its
importance as a basic component of a successful strategy of social and economic development. This
interest on social capital comes at critical crossroads for Greece. The Greek economy is the midst of a
multifaceted social and economic crisis with serious and omnipresent impact on growth,
unemployment, competitiveness and moreover on equality, social cohesion, poverty and quality of life
(Korres et al, 2014). The pressure on social cohesion intensifies the problems created by high
-54-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
unemployment and lack of economic growth and brings about poverty and deteriorating quality of life.
Existing research on the subject at a local and national level is scarce, which represents a challenge,
therefore it was considered that a new localized investigation on the subject could promote further
research and some targeted action for the development of social capital.
The annual report of the European Social Survey (ESS 2012)9 states that "social sciences, along
with natural sciences, target a specific space and time, focusing on the social and institutional
arrangements that structurally affect the human interaction" The present study intends to highlight,
investigate and measure social capital. Social capital's importance is not limited to addressing the
problems created by economic crises, but is also very valuable in promoting social recovery and
economic restructuring. It constitutes a factor of stability and sustainable development in many facets
of the economy (Christoforou, 2003).
In the authors' opinion, the consequences that the average Greek citizen experiences in his/her daily
life generate feelings of insecurity and uncertainty. No future prospects are visible in the horizon and
daily life revolves around securing survival needs. As the crisis deepens, people abandon their values
and become distrustful and introvert. As a result, there is an all- around confidence crisis, cautiousness
and devaluation of social institutions. We therefore undertake to measure social capital. We chose to
measure the dimension of participation in social networks, in order to explore the resistance of basic
social foundations such as family, relatives and friends. We also try to measure the dimension of
political participation and the level of trust in various institutions. It has been established that lack of
trust hinders economic development reforms, to the extend that policy makers do not take into account
the role and attitudes of larger social groups and promote projects that enhance uncertainty and
consequently generate social resistance (Christoforou, 2003).
The theories of holistic development are based on alternative approaches and new strategies where
factors such as social innovation and social capital will form the foundations of a new model of
development.
The central question is how can social capital contribute to the overcoming of the social crisis at the
individual, the local and regional levels. A related question is whether social capital's stock can define
the qualitative characteristics of individuals, regions or countries. On the other hand, one of the most
difficult issues that are presently debated in the literature is how can a region with low levels of trust
and community participation reestablish its social capital, replacing the various pressure groups with
rules and networks of mutual trust and cooperation (Christoforou, 2003).
9
The European Social Survey (ESS) is an academically driven multi-country survey, which has been administered
in over 30 countries to date. Its aims are, firstly – to monitor and interpret changing public attitudes and values
within Europe and to investigate how they interact with Europe's changing institutions, secondly - to advance and
consolidate improved methods of cross-national survey measurement in Europe and beyond, and thirdly - to
develop a series of European social indicators, including attitudinal indicators.
-55-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
can improve the effectiveness of societies, facilitating the coordinated actions of its members which
aim at the common benefit. (Putnam 1993).
Portes (1994), proposed a distinction based on the sources of the social capital. He introduces four
sources of social capital, the internalization of values, the exchanges based on mutuality, the forms of
social solidarity and trust, according to the motives of the community members.
Fykuyama (1995) states that social capital is generated when trust prevails among the majority of
the members of a society. Isuma (2001) defines social capital as the aggregate of relationships,
networks and groups that function on the basis of certain rules which motivate their members and guide
them into collective actions in order to achieve common goals.
According to White, L (2002) and Mathie, and Cunningham (2003), social capital consists of the
institutions, the relationships and the rules that govern social groups. The functioning and application
of the above drastically affect social interaction in a quantitative and qualitative level.
Finally, Portes (1998) maintained that social capital performs three basic functions: first, as a way
of social control, second as a source of family support and finally, as a source of obtaining benefits
through family networks.
Summarizing the above, and in a broader sense, social capital can be considered as a resource
originating in collective actions, which creates results in the social and economic spheres. During the
last years, the scientific interest around social capital keeps growing, especially in a period
characterized by continuous immigration waves, the intensification of globalization of the national
economies and the spreading of multiculturalism in advanced countries.
(Coleman, 1990 Brown & Ashman, 1996, Aldridge κ.α., 2002) or management of natural resources,
(Pretty, 2003)
In Greece, according to a study by the General Secretariat of Youth, (2011) there has been an
abrupt transition to a prolonged phase of economic crisis, with adverse economic and social effects,
which gave rise to feelings of generalized depreciation of values, rejection and insecurity. The level of
active participation of the citizens has been greatly diminished, and lack of trust and suspiciousness has
reached very high levels.
The low level of social capital in Greece has been indicated as one of the basic reasons for the slow
pace of reforms and growth, which can be explained in historical, political and social terms
(Christoforou, 2005). Several authors (Paraskevopoulos, 2006; Koniordos, 2006; Sotiropoulos, 1993),
believe that from 1960 onwards, massive participation in the political process has been gradually
reduced and is replaced by higher levels of individualism, lower levels of social trust, increased
suspiciousness, which are the characteristics of low levels of social capital. All the above are reflected
in the country's economy, and the result is that entrepreneurial activity in Greece is polarized among
family enterprises and companies based on government subsidies. These characteristics affect
development policy measures and limit wider cooperation initiatives, especially in agriculture.
(Koutsou et al, 2014).
The questions that need to be investigated are: to what extend and how is it possible for a region
with low levels of trust and citizen participation to reconstruct its social capital stock? These questions
are especially interesting in the context of a country like Greece where narrow economic interest
groups and protective client relationships with political parties pervade every angle of the public and
private sectors, impeding social reforms and economic growth. (Karametou & Apostolopoulos, 2010).
Entzioni (1993) and Fukuyama (1995) consider that it is impossible for the government to
contribute to the social capital formation/ reconstruction. On the contrary, Evans (1996) and Skocpol
(1996) maintain that positive contribution is feasible through decentralization and improved reflexes of
the government functionaries. The usual practice of structuring development programs around the
bureaucratic concentration of power and the counterproductive audit orientation, transforms these
programs into rigid and sterile procedures with minimum added value for their final beneficiaries, the
local communities. The culturally sensitive enterprises have better access to information networks and
are knowledgeable about local customs and peculiarities. It is obvious that the social and human capital
is linked with entrepreneurial culture and the possibility to benefit from changes. The high levels of
social participation and association are thought to contribute to the overall prosperity of the individuals
and their communities. (Australian Bureau of Statistics, 2004).
rural areas of the prefectures of Magnesia and Larissa. We took special care to include in our sample
only permanent residents of the above-mentioned areas, excluding temporary agricultural workers or
other professionals that work but do not live permanently in the areas under investigation. The time
frame of the research was from December 15, 2014 to February 15, 2015.
The result of this sampling effort was the collection of a sample of 225 valid questionnaires. Based
on the sampling design owe can consider that our sample is representative of a population with similar
characteristics and that its size is consistent with the requirements of the application of stratified
random sampling (Stathakopoulos, 2001).
10
www.europeansocialsurvey.org/ [Access in 7-11-2014]
-58-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
We observe that the measurement of generalized trust is rather low. The situation in the dimension
of informal networks (questions V5, V6, V7) appears better. Trust in relatives is relatively low but
devotion to family is very high and is accompanied by a relatively high importance of friendships. The
satisfaction from the functioning of democracy in the country is rather low, as is the opinion on the
decision making and functioning of local authorities and the feeling of security and satisfaction from
the local community is also low (V10, V12 και V13). On the other hand, a question on whether more
power to the local government could help improve the local economy displays a higher score,
indicating hope. Finally, the dimension of political involvement received a quite high score, confirming
that Greeks are more preoccupied than other Europeans with politics. (Sotiropoulos, 2006).
6. RESEARCH FINDINGS
The presentation of the results does not follow precisely the order of the questions in the questionnaire.
This is because demographic characteristics of the respondents were at the end, so that respondents
could concentrate in answering our questions.
The descriptive statistics (frequencies of the answers by question),11 provide the following insights:
Just 11% of the respondents definitely trust others, almost no one trusts absolutely whereas 35%
show only partial trust. About one third of the respondents trust their relatives while 35% do not really
trust them.
For 10% family is not central to their lives but 72% family is in the center of their thoughts. Most of
the respondents (about 65%) spend a lot of time meeting and communicating with friends.
Regarding the functioning of democracy in the country, 60% of the respondents are little or not at
all satisfied with only 6,7% of them indicating a high level of satisfaction..
A majority of 61% do not believe that local authorities take into account the citizens' opinions in
their decision making process. The same picture emerges from the question on the level of satisfaction
and feeling of security in the local community, where no one is perfectly satisfied and 61,3% are very
or relatively unhappy.
Lastly, on the dimension of political participation, 66,7% discuss frequently about political issues or
at least follows up political developments in the media while the percent of the politically indifferent is
limited to under 7%.
7. CONCLUSION
The general picture that emerges from the above findings is that the social capital stock in the east
Thessaly area is at a rather low level. There is a positive element, and that is the high level of trust and
participation in informal networks and in political participation, we must, however note that during the
time of the survey the political developments were of crucial importance and interest was high.
On the negative side, the levels of trust in other people and in society and the community in general,
coupled with the expressed low feeling of security, do not leave room for optimism for the future of the
society and the economy. Moreover, the level of satisfaction with the functioning of the democracy at
the national and the local levels appeared to be low. The lack of confidence in major institutions, with
the only, not very comforting exception being the armed forces, generates concern for the immediate
future. If we adopt Fukuyama's viewpoint, according to whom 13 the existence of trust in the social
network is a prerequisite for the social development which in turn will bring about economic growth, or
13
Fukuyama, (1995, 1997, 2001)
-60-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
that of Stiglitz (Stiglitz et al., 2009), who considers that social capital is a basic ingredient for economic
progress, then the reversal of the current economic depression seems very difficult.
The strong reliance on informal networks, according to Pichler & Wallace (2007) is an indication
of weakness in the characteristics of a given society in the areas he studied, since in countries where
family ties are dominant, it is more difficult for a lively citizens' society to emerge, as described in
Putnam (1993, 2000).
In concluding, once the existence and importance of social capital becomes more widely accepted,
and provided that the institutions in our country understand its added value in the fields of social
development and economic growth, then the efforts to systematically monitor its levels will intensify,
as will the efforts to enhance and grow the dimensions that constitute social capital.
The decisions for the necessary reforms in the political scene and in the social network must be
taken and their results should be monitored through repeated measurements of the level of social
capital. The superficial approach in measuring the impact of various measures, decisions and reform
actions through opinion surveys of questionable value, cover up the true problems and offer only short
term temporary gains. The transformation of a society and the structural reforms can be of value only
through their acceptance and assimilation by the society in question. The key word in order for any
changes to become incorporated in everyday life and bear fruit is the word trust. The promotion, the
measurement and wider understanding of the concept of social capital, can and should be attempted in
the fields of economics and sociology, opening up a new field in the area of human resources
management. (Trigilia, 2001, Christoforou,, 2005).
REFERENCES
Aldridge, S., Halpern, D. and Fitzpatrick, S. (2002). Social Capital: A Discussion Paper. London, England:
Performance and Innovation Unit.
Australian Bureau of Statistics (2004). Information Paper: Measuring Social Capital: An Australian Framework
and Indicators, 2004.
Babbie, E. R. (2010). Introduction to social research. Wadsworth Cengage Learning.
Bourdieu P. (1986). The Forms of capital. In: Richardson , J.G. (ed.) Handbook of Theory and Research for the
Sociology of Education New York :Grennwood Press.
Brians, L. W. C. L., Manheim, J. B., & Rich, R. C. (2011). Quantitative Analysis Lab Manual to Accompany
Empirical Political Analysis. Longman Incorporated
Brown, D. L. and D. Ashman (1996) Participation, Social Capital, and Intersectoral Problem Solving: African and
Asian Cases., World Development, Vol. 24, No.9.
Christoforou, Asimina (2005), On the Determinants of Social Capital in Greece Compared to Countries of the
European Union, Fondazione Eni Enrico Mattei (FEEM) Working Paper Series, May, Nota di Lavoro
68.2005.
Christoforou, Asimina. (2003) "Social capital and economic growth: the case of Greece." The 1st PHD symposium
on social science research in Greece. 2003.
Coleman, J. (1988) Social Capital in the creation of human capital. American Journal of Sociology, 94, 95-120.
Coleman, J.S. (1990). Foundations of Social Theory. Cambridge,MA. Harvard University Press.
Etzioni, O. (1993). Acquiring search-control knowledge via static analysis. Artificial Intelligence, 62(2), 255-301.
Evans, P. (1996). Introduction: Development strategies across the public-private divide. World development, 24(6),
IN1-1037.
Fukuyama F. (1997). The great disruption. Tanner lectures Brasenose College, Oxford University
Fukuyama, F. (1995). Trust: Social Virtues and the Creation of Prosperity. NY: Free Press
Fukuyama, F. (2001). 'Social capital, civil society and development.' Third World Quarterly 22: 7-20.
General Secretariat of Youth. (2011). Study for the enlargement and documentation of the existing situation of the
volunteerism in Greece within the European Project “European Year of Volunteerism 2011” (In Greek)
Granoveter, M. (1985). Economic Action and Social Structure: the problem of embeddedness. American Journal
of Science, 3.
Grootaert C. & Baestaler T, (2002), “Understanding and Measuring Social Capital. A multidisciplinary tool for
practitioners”. Washington D.C.: The World Bank
Halman, L., Luijkx, R. (2006). Social capital in contemporary Europe: evidence from the European Social Survey.
Portuguese Journal of Social Science, Volume 5 Number 1.
Halpern, D. (2005). Social Capital. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Hauser, C., Tappeiner, G., Walde J. (2007). The Learning Region: The Impact of Social Capital and Weak Ties on
Innovation, Regional Studies: 41:1, 75-88.
-61-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Isuma (2001) Social capital editorial. Canadian Journal of Policy Research, 2, 6–7.
Jones, N., Malesios, C., Botetzagias, I. (2009). The Influence of social capital on willingness to pay for the
environment among European Citizens, European Societies, 11(4): 511-530.
Jones, N., Malesios, C., Botetzagias, I. (2009). The Influence of social capital on willingness to pay for the
environment among European Citizens, European Societies,11(4): 511-530.
Kaasa, A. (2009). Effects of different dimensions of social capital on innovative activity: Evidence from Europe at
the regional level, Technovation: 29, 218-233.
Knack, S., and P. Keefer, 1997, “Does social capital have an economic payoff? A cross-country investigation”,
Quarterly Journal of Economics, Vol.CXII: 1251B1288.
Korres, G. et al. (2014). Financial crisis, social cohesion and development: an enlargement of the Greek economy
prospectives. Prefectural Science Letters, (1) 11-22 . (In Greek)
Koutsou, S., Partalidou, M., & Ragkos, A. (2014). Young farmers' social capital in Greece: Trust levels and
collective actions. Journal of Rural Studies, 34, 204-211.
Kyriazi, Ν. (1998), “The sociological research and the construction of social reality: The paradigm of the
quantitative approach”. Editions Typothito-G. Dardanos, Athens (in Greek).
Loury, G. C. (1977). ‘A Dynamic Theory of Racial Income Differences’, στο P. A. Wallace and A. LeMond
(επιµ.). Women, Minorities, and Employment Discrimination. Lexington, MA: D. C. Heath.
Mathie, A. and Cunningham, G. (2003) Asset-Based Community Development as a strategy for Community
Driven Development, Development in Practice, vol.13, no 5 pp.474-486.
Neilson, L.A. (2006). Social Capital and Political Consumerism: A Multilevel Analysis. Thesis dissertation. Ohio
State University.
Oorschot, W., Arts, W. (2005). The social capital of European welfare states: the crowding out hypothesis
revisited, Journal of European Social Policy: 15(1), 5-26.
Oppenheim, A. (1992). Questionnaire Design, Interviewing and Attitude Measurement. Printer, London and
Washington
Pawar, M. (2006). ‘Social Capital?’, The Social Science Journal
Pichler, F., &Wallace, C. (2007). “Patterns of formal and informal social capital in Europe”, European
Sociological Review, 23 (4), pp: 423-436.
Pippa, Ν., James, D. (2007). A continent divide? Social capital in the US and Europe. Jowell, R., Roberts, C.,
Fitzgerald, R., Eva, G.(eds.) Measuring Attitudes Cross-Nationally – Lessons from the European Social
Survey, 239-264.
Poortinga, W. (2006). Social relations or social capital? Individual and community health effects of bonding social
capital. Social Science and Medicine 63, 255–270.
Portes A. (1998). "Social capital: Its origins and applications in Modern Sociology." Annual Review of Sociology,
24, 1-24.
Pretty, J. 2003. Social Capital and Connectedness: Issues and Implications for Agriculture, Rural Development
and Natural Resource Management in ACP Countries. CTA Working Document Number 8032 World Bank.
2003. Rural Water Supply and Sanitation Project, Morocco 2003, ICR Report No. 25917
Putnam, R, D. (2000). Bowling Alone: The collapse and Revival of American Community, Simon and Schuster,
New York.
Putnam, R. et al. (1993). Making Democracy Work: Civic Traditions in Modern Italy. Princeton University Press,
Princeton, NJ.
Putnam, R.D. (2004). Commentary: 'Health by association': Some comments, International journal of
epidemiology, vol. 33, no. 4, pp. 667-671.
Putnam, RD (2003). The Prosperous Community: Social Capital and Public Life, The American Prospect (4)
Putnam, Robert D. (1993). “The Prosperous Community. Social Capital and Public Life” The American Prospect,
4 (13).
Sabatini, F. (2008). “Social Capital as Social Networks: a New Framework for Measurement and an empirical
analysis of its determinants and consequences”, Journal of Socio-Economics.
Schaik, T.V (2002). Social Capital in the European Values Study Surveys. Proceedings of the International
conference for the measurement of Social Capital, OECD-ONS, London, 25-27 September 2002.
Siardos G (2002) Methods of multivariate statistical analysis. Part two. Investigation of dependence between
variations, 3rd edn. Stamoulis Editions, Athens (in Greek)
Skocpol, T. (1996). Unravelling from above. The American Prospect, 25(20-25).
Sotiropoulos, D. (2006) Positive and negative social capital and the unequal development of the citizens’ society in
South East Europe. Science and Society journal, vol. 16/2006. (In Greek)
Sotiropoulos, D. (2007). The social capital in Greece with a comparative perspective: A concise, theoretical review
and analysis of the European Social Research results. In Politics, Society, Citizens, Data Analysis of European
Social Research, Ed. Kafetzis P., Maloutas, Th., and Tsigganou, I., pp 269-291 (In Greek)
-62-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Sotiropoulos, Dimitri. (1993). "A Colossus with Feet of Clay: The State in Post- Authoritarian Greece". In Harry J.
Psomiades and Stavros B. Thomadakis. eds. Greece, the New Europe and the Changing International Order.
New York: Pella, pp. 43-56
Stathopoulos P., (2001). Community work. Theory and practice. Ellin editions. (In Greek
Stiglitz, J. E. (2000). “Formal and informal institutions” In Partha Dasgupta and Ismail Serageldin, eds., Social
Capital: A multifaceted Perspective. Washington, D.C.: World Bank.
Stiglitz, J., Sen, A., & Fitoussi, J. P. (2009). The measurement of economic performance and social progress
revisited. Reflections and overview. Commission on the Measurement of Economic Performance and Social
Progress, Paris.
Stiglitz, Joseph (1998), “Towards a New Paradigm for Development: Strategies, Policies and Processes”, 9th Raul
Prebisch Lecture delivered at the Palais des Nations, Geneva, October 19, 1998, UNCTAD. Chapter 2 in The
Rebel Within, Ha-Joon Chang (ed.), London (UK): Wimbledon Publishing Company, 2001, pp. 57-93.
Tokalaki, A., Michailidis, A., Partalidou, M., Theodossiou, G. (2014). Crisis and social capital in Greece: Who
will manage? The rural economies – communities or the urban ones? In “The Economies of Balkan and
Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed world” Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology
(Greece), University of Nis (Serbia), 6th International Conference, May 9-10, 2014, Nis, Serbia
Trigilia, C. (2001). Social Capital and Local Development, European Journal of Social Theory 4 (4): 427-442.
White, Leroy. (2002) Connection matters: Exploring the implications of social capital and social networks for
social policy. Systems Research and Behavioral Science 19.3:255
Woolcock, Michael (1998), “Social Capital and Economic Development: Toward a theoretical synthesis and
policy framework, Theory and Society, 27:151-208
-63-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
The importance of Managerial Accounting has been proven for many years through the help it provides with the
information that creates, so there can be a better understanding on how a company operates as a result of proper
decisions. In this paper we will try to analyze one of the relative new methods of Managerial Accounting, the Time
Driven Activity Based Costing. After we compose our theoretical frame that explains this model, we will pursuit to
apply this method based on our theory in a branch of the Hellenic Post Office. The results will give us information
about the cost that is been assigned by the activities which use the company’s resources, which in our case are the
employees, and furthermore we will discover the amount of capacity that is been used properly by these resources.
KEYWORDS
JEL CLASSIFICATION
M41, M49
1. INTRODUCTION
Cost was and still is a permanent “headache” in the world of entrepreneurship. The consecutive effort
to reduce cost as much as possible has always been one of the most important fields of study from the
managers. During the last decades and specifically after the industrial revolution, there was a rapid
development of companies, which it had created the solid ground for more wealth and income increase,
but at the same time the use of new resources for production led to the substantial increase of
expenditures. When this came to sight decisions had to be made and methods had to be established in
order to trace and reduce cost.
Activity Base Cost (ABC) systems present a method in which cost is assigned in products or other
cost objects based on how much these products or cost objects use the resources of production. Activity
on the other hand is a procedure which the company uses to produce something. The more the activities
the more the cost. So the essence of this method lies in the assumption that activities are the reason that
cost is been created. In order for a system like that to be implemented has to be done in various stages
of implementation. The privileges of ABC are reflected from the complicated procedure of its
implementation. All the information that needs to be accumulated from the company’s resources
regarding cost and how these resources are occupied by the various activities, sometimes reject the
decision of implementing this model. On the other hand this utilities and the emphasis in detail is what
gives these systems the liability of their results.
Time Driven Activity Base Costing was developed with the thought to overcome the difficulties of
the ABC implementation. This model presents a different and more practical method for cost tracing in
products or other cost objects. The system is based in measuring the time of the activities which they
represent the springboard of cost allocation. The important issue with this method is that it can trace the
practical capacity so there can be found that, in what percentage the company’s resources are used
correctly, and if so which activities which does not add value and only create cost are traced. Despite
all the positive characteristics and the details of these methods (ABC & TD – ABC), most companies
still remain loyal to the usage of traditional costing systems.
-64-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
2. LITERATURE REVIEW
Cost is the cash amount that is been sacrificed for goods and services that are expected to bring
future or current incomes to the company (Mowen et al. 2014). Managers pursuit to reduce cost in
order to increase the company’s efficiency. Some of the most known traditional costing systems are:
The absorption costing; in this method it makes no difference if the cost is variable or not. Variable
cost costing; in this system the elements of the product cost change with the production stage. Job –
order costing; this system is applied in companies where in different periods we have large production
of different kind of products (Garrison & Noreen 2010). Process costing; the fundamental
characteristic of this method is that we have production of large quantities of products that are similar
to each other and not specific orders.
According to Cooper & Kaplan (1998) Activity Based Cost systems can provide great help in a
more accurate study of the production process compared to traditional cost systems and that’s the
reason they provide detailed information regarding cost.
Carolfi (1996) stated that ABC systems provide detailed information about the activities that add
value to the product as well as to those which do not. With this information the company can reduce
cost by planning products and processes which consume less activity resources, emphasizing at the
same time on eradicating the activities which do not add value to the product. Furthermore Borthick
(1995) makes clear that activities such as measuring, control and displacement increase the length of
the production process and with the current cost systems there can be a reduce on the production circle
aiming in minimizing the delay.
According to Agliati (2002) the basic characteristic of cost systems in a multinational company
can be explained by four factors: The structure of production cost of the product, the methodology that
is been used for cost tracing, and the allocation methods which support the comparisons between
service cost and support cost.
Roztocki & Weistroffer (2005) propose a new frame of work for the evaluation of information by
implementing analyzed data based on ABC & Fuzzy systems. These systems rely on the thought that
they will be useful for companies of under development economies, where the economic environment
is unstable and exists a lack of historical accounting data.
Anand (2004) presented a practical application of ABC. Issues regarding the implementation of
ABC were taken under consideration. These issues had to do with the level of success regarding the
stage of implementation of the ABC and the factors which affects it. From the 53 companies that were
examined, 23 used ABC systems for the billing the operational feedback of their products. Companies
that implemented these systems had a significant advantage in tracing the most accurate information
about cost compared to companies that had not implemented ABC systems.
Kaplan & Anderson (2007) presented Time Driven Activity Based Costing. This method demands
fewer procedures than the common ABC and yields more accurate information about cost per product
unit.
According to Bruggeman & Everaert (2007), TD – ABC isolates different characteristics of each
activity by using time equations according to which the time consumed by one activity is an operation
of different utilities. According to the equation time and cost of an activity equals the cost of the object
based on its characteristics. The method is been comprised by six stages:
1. Identify of used recourses and activities
2. Define cost of the resources
3. Calculation of the practical capacity of every source
4. Calculate unit cost per time
5. Calculate the necessary time units of each activity
6. Calculate cost of every transaction.
Terungwa (2012) studied the practical application of TD – ABC in small service companies and
analyzed the profitability of various customers. The purpose of the study was to make clear if the
implementation of TD – ABC in small companies can enhance the efficiency by causing more profit.
For making this study happen a restaurant was randomly selected and a questionnaire and interview
were used for gaining data. The result showed that using TD – ABC compared to the existed methods
already, td – abc provides more data and information regarding cost, and that managers of small
companies can use time equations to calculate the necessary time of the activities so they can improve
the costing procedure while increasing profitability.
In an article Monroy et al. (2012) there was a comparison between three methods: ABC, TD –
ABC and Lean Accounting. The comparison was made based on what information each method
-65-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
provides and impact do these informations have. The conclusion was that in Lean Accounting decision
are made based on the value stream whilst in ABC are made in the stage that every product is and in
the TD – ABC decisions are made based on the status of the product and the stage of the
implementation.
Ilhan et al. (2009) studied the profitability of different groups of customers in a 4 star hotel in
Turkey by implementing TD – ABC. The conclusion was that profitability varied in different groups
and a determinant part on this had the implementation of TD – ABC compared to the traditional cost
system that had applied already.
The effect ABC had since it was first presented in the 80s, led to substantial changes in regard to
the already existed traditional cost systems. According to the traditional cost systems a large cost pool
was used and based on that the cost allocation took place. During the production process the calculation
of direct labor cost was the most common choice for overhead cost allocation, since it was a big part of
production cost. There was this thought that a big correlation between direct labors work, total
production units and overhead cost, existed.
When companies started to create more products and services, an abundance of production
appeared. That inevitably caused a rise to overhead cost because now companies had to invest in
production planning, hiring special qualified mechanics and product designers (Garrison et al. 2010).
ABC managed to correct mistakes in overhead cost allocation, by interpreting an activity as a cost
driver. According to this method any procedure that consumes overhead resources constitutes an
activity in the production process. The bottom of the ABC system lies on the idea that a product creates
cost by causing activities which on their turn create cost. This leads us to the conclusion that since the
cost is been caused by an activity, a complex in design product will make up a larger part of cost
allocation. Next it will assign the activity cost on products, orders and clients based on the quantity of
every consumption of each operational activity.
The implementation of an ABC system takes place in these stages (Hilton 2008, Garrison &
Noreen 2010):
3.1.1 First Stage ABC
In this stage the activities that will make up the backbone of the system are identified. The
resources and the activities are shared out in five categories (Hilton et al. 2008):
• Resources that were obtained and activities which carried out for specific product units or
service.
• Resources that were obtained and activities that carried out so a group of similar products
was able to be created.
• Resources that were obtained and activities which carried out for the production and sale
of one specific product or service.
• Resources that were obtained and activities which carried out for the service of specific
customers.
• Resources that were obtained and activities that carried out so they can provide the general
capacity and warehouse for the production of goods and services.
2. Assign overhead cost to activities cost pools.
In the ABC systems the process of assigning overhead cost derives from the company’s general
ledger. The methods for this procedure are three: Direct, driven, and allocated. The precision of the
results is better during the direct and driven method. Also the cost pool activity provides more
information that helps for specific decision to be made (Noreen 1991).
3.1.2 Second Stage ABC
The activities indexes represent the total cost of each activity, towards the total activity that the
company requires so to be able to produce its current product and then to supply it to the customers.
2. Assign overhead cost to cost objects.
Here the activity indexes assign with overhead cost the products and services. Each product or
service is been assigned depending on how much quantity of the activity has consumed multiplied by
its activity index.
3.2 TD – ABC
TD – ABC was designed as a simple version of its predecessor ABC. The thought was to simplify
the complexity of gathering data. For every resources group two variables are calculated: Cost per time
unit of supply resources and how many times the units of the products consume the available resources
(Kaplan & Anderson 2004).
The implementation process of the TD – ABC comprised by 6 steps (Kaplan & Anderson 2004):
Time Drivers are used for the calculation of the usage of resources that is been done by the cost
objects. The epitome of TD – ABC lies in the fact that the measuring of resources consumption
happens based on time. The capacity of a resource pool can be measured in minutes, hours or even
years, with the total of those representing the capacity of the resource pool. There is a difference
between paid capacity and practical capacity. For the practical capacity to be calculated the time
considered for employees holiday absence, disease and matters of this nature, are not included in
the resources pool, but are taken under consideration by assuming a practical capacity of 80%
(Kaplan & Cooper 1998). In this model only the transaction drivers are been considered which are
mostly time indexes and they are determined in advance.
Time driver can have three types as variables (Bruggeman et al. 2005):
3.2.2 Activities
There are three types of activities:
-67-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
1. The case where the resource pool is only one activity and one driver.
2. The case where a number of sub activities exists.
3. The complex situation in which the sub activities cannot be identified immediately but
they have to be “designed” by a specific method studying the use of resources by the
resource pool.
This model reveals us that a process usually comprised by several sub activities but not all steps of
each reaction in a procedure are applied. In every process any likely sub activity has to be traced
and explained. Also there is a fixed time for every activity and sub activity in which this time has to
be assumed or even better measured.
The mathematical formula of this system depends on the characteristics of every activity of the
company as we mentioned (Bruggeman et al. 2005):
Then with the use of time equations the time that event E of activity A consumes shows us the
function of their several characteristics. In the end the equation has this form (Bruggeman et al.
2005):
Ρ = the number of time driver that define the time needed for activity A.
Comparing the two methods we cannot clearly say which one is better because that depends from the
circumstances of each company, the regulations of the country that the company carry out its activity,
the kind of company and of course the competitive environment. Regarding the cost tracing we can say
that the basic difference between the two lays on the element of unused capacity which TD – ABC is
capable of measuring it whilst ABC cannot. The time drivers of TD – ABC play a significant part while
the cost drivers of ABC are not adequate. Also ABC requires more time for any kind of upgrade of its
system in any new circumstances that may appear, whilst TD – ABC can simply integrate any change
by adding new driver in the time equations.
month of observation we measured the time of each activity to lead us to the creation of the necessary
time equations and also calculated the practical capacity which it will lead us also to the final results
regarding cost and how much the resources which are assigned with cost are been used. This practical
application will be based in the cost created by the employees and results will help us to conclude in
what percentage the practical capacity concurs with the paid capacity, as well as if and how much of
the unused capacity exists.
Our first step is to divide the three sectors in which activities are been carried out:
1. Back Office
2. Front Line Office
3. Gathering of Arrivals & Shipping Office
The paid capacity of the current post office is 480 (8 hrs * 60min per hour) minutes per day. This of
course is practical impossible because we have launch breaks or maybe some kind of malfunction
that can reduce this capacity time. Since there is no inside regulation about breaks, we will assume
that the practical capacity is 80% of the paid capacity (Kaplan & Anderson 1998). Thus our
practical capacity is 480min * 80% = 384 minutes per day or 11.520 minutes per month per
employee.
Back office is responsible for the pickup and the filling of post objects, which they are comprised of
simple packages and registered with bar code. We also have the registered epistles. The fixed time
here is about 5 minutes and is the duration needed for the unload of the truck. Then the filling takes
place. Simple packages take about 2 minutes and registered about 5 minutes. The filling of the
registered epistles lasts about 3 minutes. So for the back office we have three main activities, the
filling of simple packages and the filling of registered packages and registered epistles.
Cost per time unit: = cost of sector of activities / practical capacity = 5.162,29 / 23.040 (11.520 * 2
employees) = 0.22 Euros per minute.
• Time for 1st activity: fixed time + time for filing simple packages = 5min + 2min = 7 *
3.000 (monthly quantity) = 21.000 min per month.
• Time for 2nd activity fixed time + time for filling registered packages = 5min + 5min = 10
* 450 (monthly quantity) = 4.500min per month
• Time for 3rd activity = fixed time + time for filling registered epistles = 5min + 3min = 8 *
2.400 (monthly quantity) = 19.200 min per month.
Since we know the cost per unit and the time of each activity we can calculate the cost: Cost of
activity = time of activity * cost per time unit. Hence:
-69-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
• Cost of 1st activity = 7min * 0.22 Euros = 1.54 Euros * 3.000 (monthly quantity) = 4.620
Euros per month
• Cost of 2nd activity = 10min * 0.22 Euros = 2.2 Euros * 450 (monthly quantity) = 990
Euros per month
• Cost of 3rd activity = 8min * 0.22 Euros = 1.76 Euros * 2.400 (monthly quantity) = 4.224
Euros per month.
If we sum the above calculations we will see that whilst our practical capacity is 23.040 minutes the
total minutes required for the activities here are 44.700. Also the cost of the work capacity
(employees) is 5.162,29 Euros but the cost created is 9.834 Euros. The variance of these is quite
impressive.
In this sector we have two types of activities: A) activities concerning post objects, b) activities of
financial nature.
These activities deal with take & service of epistles and packages. During service of epistles and
packages, we separate them in simple and registered also. Hence we have one activity of taking simple
epistles one of registered and one activity of taking simple and registered packages. At the taking of
simple packages the employee weighs the package and prepares is for shipment, this takes about 3
minutes. For simple epistles the process is the same but due to smaller size the duration is 2 minutes. In
registered mail the process is the same but because of the scanning procedure it takes a little longer,
about 4 minutes for packages and 3 for epistles. For the service of the post objects the employee after
taking the notice ticket from the client, brings to him the current object. For simple packages the
duration is about 4 minutes. Again for registered mail with the scanning process the time increases a bit
in 6 minutes. If we have a package or epistle with C.O.D (cash on delivery) the time increases in 9
minutes.
The cost of this sector is 5.610,76 Euros per month and the practical capacity since we have four
employees, is 46.080 minutes (11.520 * 4).
1) First activity has to do with issuing order for Eurogiro payment. This service is about e-
transferring funds through cash or deposit in an account. The whole process of identification and
validation takes lasts about 3 minutes.
2) Secondly we have sending money and make payments through Western Union. The payment to
the beneficiary is done through cash for domestic or abroad payments. There is a unique 10 digit
code which the client receives after the validation of his id card etc. The time for this activity is
about 5 minutes.
-70-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
3) Third activity, payment for work insurance. This concerns part time working people (free lance
or employers), which they a certain amount to the state in order to have insurance. Including the
payment and the validation the process lasts 4 minutes approximately.
4) Next we have the simple post domestic checks. The client fills the required information on the
sheet provided by the employee and after the validation the check is been sealed. Time is about 2
minutes.
5) Then we have the domestic post check with C.O.D. The process here is similar with the simple
check plus that the employee after the validation has to take the invoice from a special deposit box.
The duration is about 5 minutes.
6) As separate activity is considered the by phone post checks. This service is for people that wish
to send money from a current post office to the recipients address. Here the employee delivers the
phone check Money Express or Money Home to the client and after the fulfillment of all
information and the validation the activity concludes. Time about 3 minutes.
7) Next activity is abroad check, simple and C.O.D. With these checks the client can send and
receive money from countries that have contracted bilateral deals. Here also we have a process of
fulfilling the necessary information by the client and then the validation by the employee. Time 4
minutes approximately.
8) Further more we have bill payments. These bills concern electricity bills, phone bills etc. The
employee collects the invoice by the client and the amount of payment after checking the date so
the payment date is not expired. After the validation and payment the employee gives the right
receipt to the client and concludes the activity. Time 2 minutes.
9) Opening a Giro account. The Giro account is a charge account and its owners can be persons or
companies. This account has no bankbook but a simple card like a credit card where all the
account’s information is written down. The whole process of opening this account takes about 7
minutes.
10) Last activity is withdrawn and deposit money in a Giro account. The client proceeds with the
card that validates he has opened a Giro account and after the validation by the employee, the
employee checks the balance of the account and the client signs the withdraw or deposit receipt.
Time about 4 minutes.
Until now we have traced 17 activities in the front line office. The fixed time for all activities is 2
minutes and has to do with the software preparation for any kind of transaction. During the day for
financial activities we have:
Cost per time unit: 4.300, 47/ 34.560 = 0.12 Euros per minute
• 1st activity = 2 + 3 = 5 minutes * 6.000 (monthly quantity) = 36.000 minutes per month
• 2nd activity = 2+ 2 = 4 minutes * 3.000 (monthly quantity) = 12.000 minutes per month
• 3rd activity = 2 + 4 = 6 minutes * 10.500 (monthly quantity) = 63.000 minutes per month
• 4th activity = 2 + 3 = 5 minutes * 3.000 (monthly quantity) = 15.000 minutes per month
• 5th activity = 2 + 4 = 6 minutes * 450 (monthly quantity) = 2.700 minutes per month
• 6th activity = 2 + 6 = 8 minutes * 2.400 (monthly activity) = 19.200 minutes per month
• 7th activity = 2 + 9 = 11 minutes * 600 (monthly quantity) = 6.600 minutes per month
-71-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
In this office the activities comprise of advancing the epistles to the front line office as well as
gathering all the post objects that have been collected by the clients to be organized and ready for
shipment. The fixed time for these activities is approximately 4 minutes and it’s the time needed for the
post objects to be organized in certain areas of the office so to be ready for shipment and for service to
the clients.
In simple packages the gathering time is about 1 minute whilst in registered epistles about 2
minutes. The same times goes for gathering cost objects for the preparation of the shipping. The cost of
this sector is 4.829 Euros.
During the day we have:
Now we can proceed to our calculations: Cost per time unit = cost of activities / practical capacity =
4.829 / 23.040 (11.520 * 2 employees) = 0.20 Euros per minute
The fixed time is 4 minutes so we have:
• 1st activity = 4 + 1 = 5 * 2.100 = 10.500 minutes per month
• 2nd activity = 4 + 2 = 6 * 2.400 = 14.400 minutes per month
• 3rd activity = 4 + 1 = 5 * 6.000 = 30.000 minutes per month
• 4th activity = 4 + 2 = 6 * 13.500 = 81.000 minutes per month
Now that we have the time equations we can calculate the cost:
• Cost of 1st activity = 5 * 0.20 = 1 * 2.100 = 2.100 Euros
• Cost of 2nd activity = 6 * 0.20 = 1.2 * 2.400 = 2.880 Euros
• Cost of 3rd activity = 5 * 0.20 = 1 * 6.000 = 6.000 Euros
• Cost of 4th Activity = 6 * 0.20 = 1.2 * 13.500 = 16.200 Euros.
If we sum the above calculations we will see that whilst our practical capacity is 23.040 minutes the
total minutes required for the activities here are 135.900. Also the cost of the work capacity
(employees) is 4.829 Euros but the cost created is 9927.180 Euros. The variance here again is very
impressive.
5. CONCLUSION
Between ABC & TD – ABC there is a difference regarding the simplification of gathering data.
Despite ABC uses very detailed methods on tracing cost, is difficult and requires a lot of time to for its
implementation. TD – ABC came to make this fact easier so it can be a considerable choice by
managers.
In this case study we wished to show if truly the TD – ABC application is easy. The basic
components of implementation which are the activities were easily tracked down personal observation
as well as interviews with the high staff. Of Course in more organized company information such of
these can be collected easier by the company’s ERP system. Based on our theory we were able to time
measure the activities and form our time equations so further calculate the cost. With our calculations
we were able to reveal the practical capacity, and we can conclude from the results that the practical
capacity is at minimum rate compared to the capacity needed for the activities to be carried out. This
means that the staff yields work more than three times their practical capacity which means in the
current office exists a serious lack of staff. Regarding cost we can also report that with less cost created
in the company (employees), is less than the cost created by the activities. Somebody can think of that
like with less cost we carry out activities that costs three times more, but in the current status that is not
so, because due to the lack of staff a serious problem of improper service to the clients is created as
well as inexpediency in performance.
REFERENCES
Agliati Marco (2002). Costing Strategies in Multinational Companies, DIR Research Division Working Paper
Anand Manoj (2004). A Review of Research in the Theory & Practice of Cost Management, South Asian Journal
of Management, Vol. 11 No. 1
Borthick, A. F., Roth H. P. (1995). Accounting for Time: Reengineering Business Processes to Improve
Responsiveness, In Readings in Management Accounting, (edited by S. M. Young), Englewood Cliffs, NJ Prentice
Hall.
Bruggeman W., Everaert P. (2007). Time Driven Activity – Based Costing: Exploring the Underlying Model, Cost
Management, Vol. 21 No. 2
Bruggeman W., Everaert P., Anderson S.R., Levant Y. (2005). Modeling Logistics Costs using Time – Driven
ABC: A Case in Distribution Company, University of Ghent, Faculty of Economics, Belgium.
Carolfi, I. A. (1996). ABM Can Improve Quality and Control Costs, Cost & Management.
Drury C. (2008). Management & Cost Accounting, 7th Edition, South - Western Cengage Learning
Fladkjaer H., Jensen E. (2011). The ABC Paradox: Is Time - Driven ABC Relevant for Small & Medium Sized
Enterprises?, Aalborg University, Department of Business & Management
Garrison R.H., Noreen E.W (2005). Managerial Accounting, 10th Edition McGraw – Hill
Guzman L., Van den Abbeele A., Cattrysse D. (2014). Time – Driven ABC Costing Systems for Cataloguing
Processes: A case study, Liber Quarterly Journal of European Research Libraries.
-73-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Hilton R. W. (2008). Managerial Accounting: Creating Value in a Dynamic Business Environment, 7th Edition
McGraw – Hill.
Hilton R.W., Maher M.W., Selto F.H. (2008). Costo Management: Strategies for Business Decisions, 4th Edition
McGraw – Hill.
Hodamipour A., Yarzdinejad E. (2014). ABC Implementation in Public & Private Sectorin Both Developed &
Developing Countries, Open Journal of Finance.
Horngreen C.T., Datar S.M., Foster G. (1997). Cost Accounting: A Managerial Emphasis, 9th Edition, Prentice
Hall.
Horngreen C.T., Sunden G.L., Schatzberg J.O. (2011). Introduction to Management Accounting, 15th Edition
Pearson.
Ilhan Dalci Veyis., Tanis Levent Kosan. (2009). Customer Profitability analysis with Time – Driven Activity Based
Costing: A Case Study in a Hotel, International Journal of Contemporary Hospitality Management, Vol. 22 No. 5
Kaplan R.S., Cooper R. (1998). Cost & Effect: Using Integrated Cost Systems to Drive Profitability &
Performance, Harvard Business School Press.
Kaplan R.S., Anderson S.R. (2004). Time Driven Activity Base Costing, Harvard Business Review.
Kaplan R.S., Anderson S.R. (2007). The Innovation of Time Driven Activity Based Costing, Cost Management
Kaplan R.S. (2009). Time Driven Activity Base Costing, Harvard Business School Press.
Monroy Carlos Rodriguez., Azadeh Nasiri & Miguel Angel Pelaez. (2012). Activity Based Costing, Time – Driven
Activity Based Costing & Lean Accounting: Differences among three accounting systems approach to
manufacturing, 6th International Conference on Industrial Engineering & Industrial Management, July
Mowen M., Hansen D.R, Heitger D.L. (2014). Cornerstones of Managerial Accounting, 5th Edition, South –
Western Cengage Learning
Morelli B., Wiberg C.J. (2002). The Standard Costing Systems at SKF, Graduate Business School, Goteborg
University.
Noreen E. (1991). Condition Under Which Activity Based Cost Systems provide Relevant Costs, Journal of
Management Accounting.
Puttema M. (2008). The Impact of Interactive use of Time – Driven Activity Based Costing Information on
Organizational Capabilities, University of Ghent, Faculty of Economics, Belgium.
Roztocki Narcyz., Weistroffer Heinz Roland. (2005). Evaluating Information Technology Investments: A Fuzzy
Activity – Based Costing Approach, Journal of Information Science & Technology Vol. 2 No. 4.
Terugwa A. (2012). Practicability of Time – Driven Activity Based Costing on Profitability of Restaurants in
Makundi Metropolis of Benue state, Nigeria, Journal of Contemporary Management.
Walther L.M. (2010). Cost Analysis: Managerial & Cost Accounting, 1st Edition, EBook, www.bookboon.com
APPENDIX
Payroll
-74-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
In this study Greek unemployed people’s general attitude to working across organizational boundaries is
examined. In addition, the survey tries to supplement the shortage of relevant researches in Greece and it attempts
to examine the employment mobility of Greek unemployed job seekers. The sample consists of 400 Greek
unemployed people, who expressed their perceptions regarding occupation mobility and more specifically
regarding boundaryless mindset careers. Boundaryless Career Attitudes Scale, constructed by Briscoe & Hall
(2006) was used in this study. Analyse Factorielle des Correspondences was used for the analysis of the data. The
results revealed a strong differentiation among respondents and showed positive, negative, or neutral attitudes
towards boundaryless mindset career.
KEYWORDS
Employment, Boundaryless mindset
3. THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK
In the past the working landscape was characterized by traditional forms of employment such as full
and stable employment in an organization for a lifetime (Cappelli, 1999). Nowadays the concept of
career seems to get further and further from the old linear model moving towards a more dynamic and
complex model of career (Cameron, 2009). This modern concept of career has influenced many
theorists, who have produced contemporary career frameworks and models. The intelligent career
model (Arthur, Claman & DeFillippi, 1995), is one of them and also the theoretical basis for the
construction of Boundaryless Career Attitudes Scale (Briscoe, Hall & DeMuth, 2006).
4. RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
mset_q_24: I like to work with people outside a single organization, mset_q_25: I like jobs that require
me to interact with people working in other organizations or businesses, mset_q_26: I like to seize
opportunities that allow me to work outside of a single organization, mset_q_27: I am open in new job
experiences and situations).
To analyze the data we used Correspondence Factorial Analysis (Benzecri, 1973). By using this type of
analysis we manage to almost entirely describe the phenomenon with the help of a smaller number of
new composite independent variables, the so called factors. These factors, which take the form of axes,
vertical by two, are the factorial axes and they are created by the formation of groups of the initial
variables. The result of this process is that the search for relations among the variables becomes all the
more revealing.
The results of the Factorial Correspondence Analysis are interpreted in the first factorial level, the one
created by the two first factorial axes.
The indices used by interpreting the results of the particular factorial analysis of correspondences, are
the familiar indices ‘inertia’, ‘contribution’ and ‘correlation’. These indices allow us to immediately
discern the most important and determining variables or objects, which contribute to the creation of
factorial axes. We interpreted the results of this factorial analysis by means of inertia, which every
factorial axis explains, and finally by means of correlation and contribution (Anastasiadou and
Papadimitriou 2001; Anastasiadou and Anastasiadis, 2011a; Anastasiadou, 2011b). M.A.D. program
created by Karapistolis (2000) was used for this specific analysis and it informs both for the quality of
appearance and the contribution of variables’ attributes to the construction of factorial axes, thus the
items/ variables that contribute to the greatest degree to the construction of the axes, their graphs and
their factorial planes.
5. RESULTS
Interpretation of the first factorial axis e1: The first factorial axis e1 interprets 46,67% of the total data
dispersion (Diagram 1). Moving on to the axis from left to right we note the gradation of the
respondents’ stance. Initially we observe a negative stance concerning not only the utilization of
opportunities offering them the possibility to become active even outside the working environment of
an institution or business (mset_q_261) (Cor=650, Ctr=86), the involvement in projects with people
coming from different institutions or businesses (mset_q_211) (Cor=513, Ctr=59), the assignments
requiring interaction with people working in other institutions or businesses (mset_q_251) (Cor=617,
Ctr=81) but also the collaboration with people outside a single organisation or business (mset_q_241)
(Cor=592, Ctr=71). Additionally, the questionnaire takers do not have a clear attitude as to whether
they like to be given the possibility to learn new things within their work (mset_q_202) (Cor=430,
Ctr=45).
Then we come across expressions of intensely negative attitudes concerning the potential feelings of
enjoyment, deriving from being assigned duties, which allow them to work outside the premises of an
institution or business (mset_q_221) (Cor=718, Ctr=81) and assuming duties, which require them to
work in other posts too within an institution or business (mset_q_231) (Cor=554, Ctr=45). On the right
side of the axis we find respondents, who like to exploit opportunities which offer them the possibility
to work outside the premises of an institution or business (mset_q_223) (Cor=596, Ctr=51), who like
working with people outside a single institution or business (mset_q_243) (Cor=720, Ctr=69), who
like projects requiring them to interact with people working in other organisations or businesses
(mset_q_253) (Cor=765, Ctr=75) and finally, they like assuming duties which dictate that they work in
other posts too existing in an institution or business (mset_q_233) (Cor=515, Ctr=50).
-76-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
In greater detail, on the left of the first factorial axis there are the classes determining the absolutely
negative attitude of the respondents towards work outside the organizational frame and anything
concerning assuming responsibility, duties or taking initiative within and without the work place. On
the contrary, on the right of the first factorial axis there are the classes, which define the entirely
positive mentality of the participants in the survey on labor mobility. Namely, the arrangement of the
attitudes on the first factorial axis defines the divergence of work culture in the work place. Thus, we
may assume that the first axis conveys a new composite variant, which determines the true divergence
in the mobility culture.
We can therefore deem that the first axis expresses a new composite variable, which defines the
differentiation of the culture mobility of the participants regarding work within and without
organizational boundaries.
Interpretation of the second factorial axis e2: As we applied the Factorial Analysis of Correspondences
we observe that the second factorial axis, which interprets 16,41% of total dispersion (Diagram 2)
differentiates the respondents who are not in a position to accurately determine the role of the
consolidated mentality of labor mobility from those who have a negative attitude in order to break free,
and get out of the restrictive limits of the institution or business where they are professionally active.
-77-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
More elaborately, on the left of the first factorial axis those participants are lined up, who do not have a
crystallized view as to how much they like work that requires them to interact with people, who work
in other organizations or businesses (mset_q_252) (Cor=634, Ctr=143) as well as how much they like
to exploit opportunities, which offer them the possibility of becoming active outside the working
environment of an institution or business (mset_q_262) (Cor=405, Ctr=95), how much they enjoy
being assigned duties, which allow them to work outside the premises of an institution or business (
mset_q_222) (Cor=352, Ctr=70), how much they like assuming duties which require of them to work
in different posts within an institution or business (mset_q_232) (Cor=320, Ctr=57) and how much
they like working in projects with people from different institutions or businesses (mset_q_212)
(Cor=236, Ctr=42). On the right of the axis those respondents are lined up, who hold a negative stance
as to whether they like projects, which demand of them to interact with people working in other
institutions or businesses (mset_q_251) (Cor=217, Ctr=81).
We note that the arrangement of the perceptions on labor mobility begins with the lack of view as to
the wish to interact with people of another work environment outside the institution or business
developing new relationships and collaborations, participating in projects, undertaking responsibilities,
to end up in denying the possibility of interacting with employees in other institutions or businesses.
Thus, the arrangement of perceptions in the first factorial axis highlights a new factor, which can be
considered as determining of the degree of neutrality in mobility culture.
First factorial plane e1 x e2: The first factorial plane e1xe2 explains (Diagram 3) the 63,08% of total
inertia – information, a particularly satisfactory percentage.
Due to the fact that the first factorial axis juxtaposes the extreme cases and the second the one in the
middle, we observe that the appearance of the cloud of the first factorial level takes the form of a
parabola, which means we have the Guttmann case.
In the level e1xe2 in the extremes of the parabola we find the extreme situations while in the concave
the medium ones.
-78-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Indeed, towards the endpoints of the parabola the stances of the participants in the survey are
contrasted, the negative attitudes towards labor mobility on the left part, opposite the positive stances
regarding the willingness for mobility both within and without the organization on the right. The cases
in the middle are in the minimum of the curve where we locate the neutral attitudes regarding the
mentality of boundaryless career. Between the endpoints and the minimum of the Guttmann parabola
from the left to the right we find the negativeness of the respondents and the positive attitude. In the
area of the minimum and around the center of gravity there are the neutral attitudes regarding the labor
mobility culture.
More specifically we discern the creation of three clouds in the four quadrants clearly demarcated.
Each cloud includes a series of variables, where the stances of individuals towards labor mobility are
evidently imprinted.
In the first quadrant (e1 + e2+) we find participants in the survey, whose statements mset_q_233,
mset_q_253, mset_q_232, mset_q_263, mset_q_213, demonstrate that they like to undertake tasks
requiring them to work in other posts of the organization or business where they already work
(mset_q_233) (Cor=515, Ctr=50), they like tasks, which require them to interact with people working
in other institutions or businesses (mset_q_253) (Cor=765, Ctr=75), they like to cooperate with people
outside a single organization or business (mset_q_243) (Cor=740, Ctr=69), they enjoy undertaking
tasks which allow them to work outside the premises of an institution or business (mset_q_223)
(Cor=596, Ctr=51), they like to utilize opportunities which allow them to become active not only inside
but also outside the working environment of an organization or business (mset_q_263) (Cor=765,
Ctr=57), and they like to work in projects with people from different institutions or businesses
(mset_q_213) (Cor=653, Ctr=49).
-79-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
In the second quadrant (e1 −, e2 +) we find these people, whose attitudes towards boundaryless career
are expressed in properties mset_q_251, mset_q_211, mset_q_241, mset_q_261, mset_q_221,
mset_q_202, mset_q_231. More specifically, we observe statements conveying dislike to tasks
requiring interaction with employees of other organizations or businesses (mset_q_251) (Cor=617,
Ctr=81), they don’t like working in projects with people coming from different institutions or
businesses (mset_q_211) (Cor=513, Ctr=59), they don’t like cooperating with people outside a single
institution or business (mset_q_241) (Cor=592, Ctr=71), they don’t enjoy being assigned duties, which
allow them to work outside the premises of an organization or business (mset_q_221) (Cor=718,
Ctr=81), they have a neutral stance regarding if they like learning new things through their work
(mset_q_202) (Cor=430, Ctr=45), they do not like undertaking tasks which require them to work in
other posts within an organization or business apart from their own (mset_q_231) Cor=554, Ctr=45).
( ) ( )
In the third e −, e − and fourth e1+, e2 + quadrant we observe the team whose attitudes concerning
1 2
boundaryless career are displayed by properties (mset_q_212, mset_q_232, mset_q_222, mset_q_262,
mset_q_242, mset_q_252, which state that people asked have a neutral stance regarding whether they
like working in projects with people coming from different organizations or businesses (mset_q_212)
(Cor=236, Ctr=42), if they like assuming work duties, which require them to work in other posts except
their own within an institution or business (mset_q_232) (Cor=320, Ctr=57), if they enjoy being
assigned responsibilities offering them the possibility of working outside the area of an organization or
business (mset_q_222) (Cor=352, Ctr=70), if they like to make the most of opportunities, which allow
them to become active outside the working environment of an institution or business (mset_q_262)
(Cor=405, Ctr=95), if they like cooperating with people outside a single organization or business
(mset_q_242) (Cor=549, Ctr=119) and finally, if they like projects requiring them to interact with
people working in other institutions or businesses (mset_q_252) (Cor=634, Ctr=143).
6. CONCLUSIONS
Three groups of respondents were created. Two of them have a clear attitude and the third group is
neutral towards the prospect of boundaryless career.
The first group of respondents does not negotiate their career outside the organization or business
where they work. Even the prospect of cooperating with people working in other institutions or
businesses seems unthinkable for them because even work duties and employment in another post
within the same organization or business, or in tasks outside the institution or business do not agree
with them or make them happy. This group is negative to any change at work.
The second group consists of respondents, who are flexible regarding their employment in other posts
within the organization or business, they are positive towards associating with colleagues working in
other institutions or businesses, they are happy to work not only in but also outside the work
environment of the organization or business, where they already work.
The third and last group is neither favorably nor negatively disposed regarding boundaryless career.
REFERENCES
Anastasiadou, S, and Papadimitriou, I. (2001). Another way to estimate the validity of a questionnaire for
measurement of attitudes towards statistics: The case of Greek students. In A. Gagatsis (Eds). Learning in
Mathematics and Science and Educational Technology, (pp. 345–368). Nicosia: Intercollege Press.
Anastasiadou, S, and Anastasiadis, L. (2011a). Reliability and validity testing of a new scale for monitoring
attitudes toward electronics and electrical constructions subject. International Journal of Applied Science and
Technology, 1–10.
Anastasiadou, S. (2011b). Reliability and validity testing of a new scale for monitoring attitudes toward learning
statistics with technology. Acta Didactica Napocensia 4(1), 1–10.
Arthur, M. B., Claman, P. H., & DeFillippi, R. J. (1995). Intelligent enterprise, intelligent career. Academy of
Management Executive, 9(4), 7–20.
Benzecri, J-P. (1973). L’ Analyse Donnees. Paris: Dunod.
Briscoe, J. P., Hall, D. T., & DeMuth, R. L. F. (2006). Protean and boundaryless careers: An empirical exploration.
Journal of Vocational Behavior, 69, 30–47.
Cameron, R. (2009). Theoretical Bridge-Building: The Career Development Project for the 21st Century Meets the
New Era of Human Resource Development. Australian Journal of Career Development, 18(3), 9-17.
Cappelli, P. (1999). Career Jobs Are Dead. California Management Review, 42, 146–167.
-80-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
The capital resources in developing countries are very important for the country’s economic development. The
development of capital markets provides the country with access to domestic and foreign financial resources. It
channels funds from savers to investors and businesses and also attracts foreign investors. However, one of the
conditions for this development is the existence of legislation related to securities.
This kind of legislation does exist in Albania. This article tries to identify the evolution of this legislation, along
with its deficiencies. By comparing it to the legislation in neighbouring countries, where the securities market is
more developed than Albania’s (the stock market was closed a few months ago), we conclude that the regulatory
basis exists, but it has some problems. The first securities law implemented in 1996 was not proven to be
appropriate because of the absence of securities trading. Derivatives are an important element in developed
financial markets and financial engineering, and their criteria are well specified in the respective legislation. The
financial crisis in 2008, which started in the USA and spread throughout Europe, showed the importance of
defining and predicting every element of derivative contracts. According to the Albanian legislation, these
derivatives are not included in the securities category, making this legislation deficient.
Lending and borrowing securities are among the most risky and speculative financial activities. They are very
profitable, but have limited usage due to the risks they carry. This process is mentioned in the law, but with no
further specifications and without mentioning its limitations in the Albanian legislation. There are also other
indications absent from the Albanian legislation, such as the rules for the sequence of executing an order. In
addition, the type of orders, which are considered very important elements by the literature, are neither mentioned
nor specified. All the above-mentioned elements make this topic a very important one to be studied in Albania.
KEYWORDS:
securities, legislation, financial market
1. INTRODUCTION
The legislature grounds of securities in America were introduced in the 1930s to re-establish public
confidence in the securities market after the stock market crash of 1929. It aimed to protect small
investors against companies that traded securities, which promised a high rate of returns.
Seventy-five years later, the market faced a similar problem, which required efforts and
interventions to reinstate confidence in the securities market. However, this time market conditions
were different from the initial ones. Today this problem does not stem from “speculative schemes” but
from management errors or fraud. The financial crisis of 2007–2008 is perceived as the manifestation
of the excessive risks that managers undertook incentivized by short-term bonuses, destroying long-
term valuable companies. This collapse came as a result of inappropriate risk management and lack of
managerial accountability to the corporate board of directors.
In Europe, the European Commission14 has for years reviewed the obstacles in the European
securities markets in order to create a safe and highly functional market. The European Union (EU) has
prepared the legislation in this area asking for the harmonization of legislation among member
countries.
14
http://ec.europa.eu/finance/financial-markets/securities-law/index_en.htm
-81-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Recently, as a result of the financial crisis, important efforts were made by the regulatory
institutions of the EU to create a sustainable financial system for the future. Legal uncertainties
associated with instability risks create significant obstacles to the market. They limit cross-border
activities among investors as well as lowering confidence against investors’ protection.
In 2007, Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID)15, a European Union directive, was
approved in order to offer harmonized regulation for the investment services among 31 member states
of the European Economic Zone (28 European Union members plus Iceland, Norway and
Lichtenstein). The main objectives of the directive are increased competition and improved consumer
protection in investment services.
MiFID is the foundation of the European Commission’s plan that assists the financial services. As
of 1 November 2007, it replaced the Investment Services Directive (ISD) while preserving its
principles but also including the concept of “maximum harmonization”, which emphasizes mainly the
supervision of the country within its borders. This is different from the previous legislation of the
European Union, which presented a “minimum harmonization” among countries with minimum
freedom.
MiFID, which was validated through the standard procedures together with the decision of the
European Union Council and European Parliament, specifies a detailed framework for the legislation.
Twenty articles of this directive specify technical measures that need to be implemented. These
measures were approved by the European Commission based on technical advice from the Committee
of European Securities Regulators (CESR) and the supervision of the European Parliament. The
measures were published in the form of an official directive on 2 September 2006 and it has been
validated from November 2007.
The first law approved on securities was that on “Securities”, Nr. 8080 of 3 May 1996, which was
not applicable. It was replaced by another law, named “Title Securities”. This law, Nr. 9879 of 21
February 2008, defines securities as financial instruments that are issued and traded for profit purposes
through the administration of the rights that come from their possession. Based on the definition of
securities, they are composed of title securities and derivative instruments. Derivative financial
instruments – instruments whose prices are directly or indirectly linked to securities prices, exchange
rates, stock exchange indexes, or interest rates – according to the law, are not title securities. The
definition given to “title securities” in this law is also appropriate for the derivative financial
instruments because through them the holder aims to create profits by offsetting the possible losses.
The law does not explain or argue why derivatives are not considered to be title securities or why they
15
http://ec.europa.eu/finance/securities/isd/index_en.htm
16
“International Differences in the Cost of Equity Capital: Do Legal Institutions and Securities Regulation
Matter?” Luzi Hail Christian Leuz, Journal of Accounting Research, 2006
-82-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
are not included in the definition of securities. In contrast to the Albanian law, in regional countries,
derivatives are considered to be title securities and are widely traded as an alternative for investors.
The main regional stock exchanges where these titles are traded are: Athens Stock Exchange,
Zagreb Stock Exchange and Bucharest Stock Exchange. Furthermore, one of the objectives of the
Athens Stock Exchange is the development and organization of the title securities markets including
derivatives17.
The goal of financial derivatives is realizing speculative profits, in an attempt to profit from the
fluctuations of a security’s price from its initial price. The term “derivative” indicates securities, prices
of which are derived from the prices of stocks, goods, indexes, interest rates and exchange rates.
Derivatives are very important in risk management and are considered a means of protection against
losses. However, they are a source of risk for the stability of the financial markets and as a result for
the whole economy. Evidence exists for this from 2,350 years ago, when Aristotle discussed an issue of
manipulation of the market by the usage of derivatives.
Today, the derivatives market is considered very important and it is claimed that it exceeds the
insurance and credit markets. Data from the Bank for International Settlements (BIS)18 shows that
derivative transactions in the Over The Counter (OTC) market exceed $197.2 trillion. Despite the
international development of derivatives in the global market, the Albanian law does not recognize
derivatives as title securities.
In the bonds section in the law of “Title Securities”, bonds are defined as “long-term debt title,
which obligates the issuer to pay to the bond holder on a specified date, in one or more installments, the
nominal value and the interest rate.” Furthermore, the law indicates the issuance conditions, the type of
bonds and the general elements that a debt contract contains. However, the law does not specify the
contract conditions and the rights and the obligations of the parties legally involved in the contract.
A different situation is presented in the regional countries, where contract conditions are
specifically defined19. The absence of a capital market and the lack of availability of financial
instruments may have influenced the incompleteness of the law. In other Balkan countries the situation
is very different. The bonds market is developed and operates not only in organized markets (stock
exchanges) but also in other countries such as Croatia, Serbia and Macedonia20. Nevertheless, it is less
developed and does not attract as much interest compared to the stock market.
“The activities related to the transactions of title securities” section treats all the transactions
associated with the title securities as well as all the auxiliary processes that relate to transactions such
as the advisory process, clearing process, settlements and title securities registration, finishing with the
sales process of these titles. According to the law, the brokerage takes on the role of the financial
intermediary assisting the designing process of the issuance of the security. The broker also purchases
or partially purchases the issuance of the securities to sell it to the public. Section 52, “The initial
capital of the brokerages” completes Section 42 classifying brokerages as:
• Brokerage companies that offer basic services (purchasing, selling and advice). Initial capital
needed is 6,000,000 Lek.
• Brokerage companies that offer different services from those stated above, such as portfolio
management, lending securities, repurchase agreements etc. Initial capital required is
15,000,000 Lek.
• Brokerage companies that are solely engaged in the issuing process of securities. Initial capital
required is 75,000,000 Lek.
The statute of these companies has an ascending order, meaning that the companies towards the
end of the order have a higher risk in the endurance of their activities compared to other categories.
However, the law does not specify whether the brokerage companies would have the right to perform
all the activities included in the sections and what would happen to the initial capital and the changes it
would be accompanied with.
In Section 70 of the law, it is stated that brokerage companies can borrow or lend without
specifying any procedure to be followed or any limitation concerning the activity of borrowing and
lending. Borrowing and then lending securities involves one specific account, which is actually the
short selling process mentioned in the section. As this is a highly risky transaction, the law should have
17
http://www.ase.gr/default_en.asp
18
https://www.bis.org/
19
“The Market for Corporate Convertible Bonds in Serbia”, Sir Paul Judge, Deloitte 2011.
20
“Effects of capital markets development on economic growth of Western Balkan countries.”, Artor Nuhiu, Arbër
Hoti, Iliria International Review – 2012.
-83-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
been better formulated in a more concise way to better specify the limitations. In addition, the bylaws
associated with this law should have been well defined.
This law also treats the giving and holding process and the execution of the orders by brokerage
companies. However, further specifications should have been made in the bylaws of the authorities.
What this law does not define is the sequence of the order executions, which academia considers as
very important. Not only academia, but also the legislation in every country specifies aspects of such
activities21.
In the law and the regulation we observe another important figure in the title securities market,
which in the law is stated as “investment adviser” and in the regulation “investment advisory
company”. In the hope that the former and the latter refer to the same matter, I would like to add a few
comments by comparing this figure with the commissioning company and the brokerage firm.
The law states that one of the activities that a commissioning company can undertake is
“investment advice”, while the regulation states that it has to be involved in trading title securities as
well as giving advice to clients regarding the purchasing and selling of titles as part of their activity.
Meanwhile, in the regulation, the advisory process includes the continuous advice for profitable
reasons. Under the law this is an activity that should be provided by the investment adviser or the
investment advisory company. It seems that there is a conflict between the two above specifications,
creating confusion in defining their functions. In general, literature refers to brokerage companies as
companies that offer simple services such as purchasing or selling, known as discount brokers. Apart
from these services they can also offer advice, which classifies them as full-service brokers. Regulation
on the stock exchange and the activities of the participants specifies their activities in detail22.
Furthermore, in the statute of all brokerage firms, based on the law of the country where they operate,
the activity is well determined as well as the investor relations23.
3. CONCLUSION
One of the main conditions for the financial development of an economy is the existence of
legislation regarding financial titles. Legal uncertainties associated with stability risks present obstacles
to the effective functioning of the market. They limit the cross-border market and traders’ confidence.
Comparing our national legislation to that of neighbouring countries, where the securities market is
more developed compared to Albania, we can draw the conclusion that a regulatory framework exists
but has some gaps.
The first law, Nr. 8080 on “Securities” dated 3 May 1996, was not applicable; it was replaced by
another law entitled “Title Securities”. Based on the definition given to securities, they are composed
of title securities and derivative financial instruments. Hence, securities are not considered to be title
securities. In contrast to Albania, the regional countries widely trade derivative instruments, which are
also considered to be title securities.
The Albanian law does not specify the conditions of the contract, the rights and the obligations of the
parties involved in the bond contract. In the Balkan countries the contract conditions are well specified.
The absence of the capital market and the lack of the trade of instruments may have influenced the lack
of proper specifications of the law.
To follow, the Albanian law does not specify whether a brokerage company would undertake all the
activities presented in the sections of the law, or what would happen to the charter capital of it.
We recommend that this law, unlike the previous one on “Securities”, Nr. 8080 of 3 May 1996, should
be applied rigorously.
REFERENCES
Atanasov, V., Bernard, Black., Ciccotello, C., Gyoshev , Stanley, 2010. “How Does Law Affect Finance? An
Examination of Equity Tunneling in Bulgaria”, Journal of Financial Economics.
Hail, L., Leuz, C., 2006, “International Differences in the Cost of Equity Capital: Do Legal Institutions and
Securities Regulation Matter?”, Journal of Accounting Research.
21
http://www.linguee.com/english-greek/translaton/brokerage+fee.html
22
http://www.ase.gr/default_en.asp
23
http://www.bac.bg
-84-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Nuhiu, A., Hoti, A., 2011, “Effects of capital markets development on economic growth of Western Balkan
countries.” Iliria International Review.
Christensen, H., Hail, L., Leuz , C., 2014, “Capital market effects of Securities Regulation”, Finance Working
Paper N° 407/2014.
Sir Paul Judge, 2011, “The Market for Corporate Convertible Bonds in Serbia”, Deloitte
Zingales, L., 2009, “The Future of Securities Regulation”, National Bureau of Economic Research (NBER).
http://ec.europa.eu/finance/financial-markets/securities-law/index_en.htm
http://ec.europa.eu/finance/securities/isd/index_en.htm
http://www.ase.gr/default_en.asp
https://www.bis.org/
http://www.ase.gr/default_en.asp
http://www.bac.bg/
-85-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
The aim of this paper is to meditate which are the audit procedures which external auditors should
follow in order to edit the annual tax certificate of a SA. The work of the auditors is vital to be
surrounded by clear procedures and plans, to ensure the validity and objectivity of the audit.
KEYWORDS
Auditor, Control certificate, Withholding tax.
1. INTRODUCTION
The business income is a key level of the economic growth. In recent years, the collection of
revenue due to the economic crisis we are experiencing, it has become vital for the state. Therefore, in
a constantly changing economic and political environment of the parties that compose it and their
activities must be adapted as effectively as possible to the new conditions in order to achieve their
goals. The result is to have more and better control of enterprises for any willful or unintentional
irregularities. The business control is a key objective for the successful collection of revenues. An
important role constitutes the audit profession, which is in control of the published financial statements
of a company, to verify the reliability, objectivity and their validity. The auditors are obliged to issue
the tax certificate that records if there are any tax offenses. The establishment of the tax certificate is an
important step towards our tax system modernization and achieving transparency in tax audits of
businesses.
methodology applied, and any observations existing for each item we will audit. Audit of tax items are:
a) VAT, b) withholding taxes, c) property tax.
WITHHOLDING TAX
(a) There were an audit on the declaration and return of the 20% tax withhold from wages of freelances
(article 58 L.2238/94) where the transaction exceeds three hundred Euros (300).
-87-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
From the audit which have been archived both on the records and the information of the target
company and on the accounts 61.00 «Freelancers with withholding taxes» and 54.04.00 «Pay tax of
freelancers» it emerged that there were three invoices from the company IKE, with vat ID 0000000,
which does not constitute on act of freelancers, according to paragraph 1 of article 48 of L.2238/94, as
its income is considered as source D (incomes from commercial operations) therefore should not be
carried out withholding tax on its fess. As a result the withholding tax should be returned to the State.
In addition, the audit showed that there where invoices which are below 300 Euros which has
conducted withholding tax, as opposed to the paragraph 1of article 58 of the Income Tax Code,
indicating that there is no withholding tax on invoices under 300 Euros. Finally, in the second two
months the withholding tax has not been property because two invoices have been calculated
incorrectly. The resulting difference should be attributed to the State.
Then we will focus on controlling of payroll, where there are numerous deductions from wages.
Among the most important deductions are the deductions for social insurance tax, income tax for
workers and since 2010 the special solidarity levy.
The controlled company during the accounting period examined has employed wage and salaried
staff, which paid wages that are subject to withholding payroll tax (payroll tax), according with the
provisions paid down in article 57 of L.2238/1994. The audit company is obliged to withhold and there
give to the State the payroll tax corresponding to the aforementioned fees, as defined in article 59
paragraphs 1 of L.2238/1994.
From the audit which have been done both on the kept book’s and information of the company,
specially on the monthly payroll statements and on the accounts 60.00 «Fees paid staff», 60.01 «Fess
staff salaries» and 54.03 «Taxes and fees payroll», we found that the company did not paid, as it
should, the withholding payroll taxes to State.
The audit found that there was incorrect withholding tax in six workers so we increase the sample
in ten workers, which we found that the improper withholding tax continues, which should be
attributed to the State.
Then we will try to present the image about the deductions which are made by the companies for
the Social Insurance Contributions of workers in Europe.
a) A percentage of profits.
b) Other fess
• Fixed compensation per session or representation expenses
• Fees due to special valuations
• Remuneration paid in any other way
For the amounts which Board receives in any other way the company should the statements to the
Authority until 25 of January, every year.
From 1/1/2014 based on the new tax law 4172/2013 remunerations of board of the company or any
other legal entity, is considered income from employment.
Based on the audit which have been done on the account 61.01.00 « Remuneration Meetings of
Board », 54.04.03 «Tax fess of Board » and 54.09.04 « Stamp and Oga fees of Board », has shown
that they done property and paid withholding tax to the State.
Additionally, according to new income tax law 4173/2013 article 64, obligated to apply statements
and payment of the tax of 3% which is withhold is every legal entity or every individual which is doing
business and has its tax residence in Greece, the general government bodies or every taxpayer which
have not its tax residence in Greece but operates through a permanent establishment in Greece. These
entities are obligated to present a temporary application the latest until the end of the second month on
the website www.gsis.gr.
Below is a control panel model.
(a) There were an audit on the declaration and return the withholding tax of 3% (1% from
27/05/2009 until 31/12/2010) on the value of the manufactured project or rent renting public, municipal
or port annuities (Articles 55 and 60 L.2238 / 94).
The audit which have been done, based the regard to records and data of the controlled
undertaking and accounts 61.93.23 "Subcontractors Fees science 3% VAT 23% "and 54.04.01" Taxes
Contractors 3% "was properly withheld 3% and the paid tax to the State.
4. CONCLUSION
-89-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The current tax system in Greece is quite complicated because of too many provisions that change
quite often and are imposed on both businesses and taxpayers.
In recent years, the collection of revenue due to the economic crisis we are experiencing, it has
become vital for the state. This is the reason why business auditing has been increased. Based on what
we have analyzed in this paper is perceived that most companies do not pay their obligations to the
state.
In order to have an effective tax system is required a tax reform based on transparency, integrity,
simplicity, stability and fairer laws. When all of these will be accomplished we will have a country that
inspires confidence, will have a greater degree of attracting foreign direct investment and there will be
no suspicion between government and business.
Several attempts have been made so that Greece can keep up with the other countries of the
European Union. At first applied International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) in listed
companies on the Stock Exchange. Then created the Greek Accounting Standards and after that the
International Auditing Standards. All these standards are intended to correct and fully inform the
investors, the shareholders and the public. They focus on the value and the importance of the control.
They enhance confidence and transparency.
This study aims to verify in practice the control carried out by the auditors based Control Program
regarding the special tax liabilities of companies. Proposal for further investigation would be to
carrying out research on companies listed on the Athens Stock Exchange, before and after the
implementation of the International Audit Standards, to be able to see what would be the differences
that will result in control of tax.
REFERENCES
Giannakouris, Pa. and Koukovinis, Va., 2007. The Value Added Tax. Puplishers Stamoulis,Athens, Greece.
Siotis, Th. and Zoitsas, Ag., 2009. The modern Auditing. Publishers Sofias, Thessaloniki, Greece.
Karagiannis, I. et al, 2011. Vat- Declarations in practice .Publishers Karagiannis., Thessaloniki, Greece.
Tsiatouras, Ag., 2014. Vat. Publishers Arnaoutis. Athens, Greece.
Kanzos, K. and Xontraki, A., 2006. Auditing Theory and Practice. Publishers Stamoulis, Athens, Greece.
Farmakis, N., 2007. Payroll Staff-VAT. Publishers Afoi Xaralampidi O.E.. Serres, Greece.
Kollia, A., 2012, Taxation - Real Estate .Publishers Kintrov E.P.E.. Thessaloniki, Greece.
Mastrogianni, F., 2014. The single property tax, the code communal property and E9. Publishers Stamoulis,
Athens, Greece.
Pol 1159/22-07-2011
Law 2238/1994
Law 3842/2010
Law 3693/2008
Law 4172/2013
-90-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Company acquisitions play an important role in the corporate strategic development and international expansion.
This paper investigates the risk assessment process in the pre-acquisition phase by means of due diligence. The
purpose of the paper is to establish vital link between research and practice, exploring the risk areas to make an
informed decision. Due diligence audit conforms to the organizational learning theory, proposing that the more the
acquiring firm learns about the acquisition target, the higher the probability of successful acquisition.
The empirical evidence is drawn by using data sample of acquisitions of German and Austrian automotive
companies in the Central and Eastern European markets. The results support the proposition that due diligence
audit is necessary for successful acquisition. The hypothesis of assessing business capabilities and workforce
knowledge, technological skills and other capabilities enhances the probability of successful cross-border
acquisition. In line with that, the trend of gaining further control along the chain value in the automotive industry is
comprehended.
The originality of the paper is given by unique acquisition risk analysis in the academic literature complemented
by practical expert studies from mergers and acquisitions advising companies.
KEYWORDS
due diligence, emerging markets, mergers and acquisitions, risk assessment,
1. INTRODUCTION
The topic of mergers & acquisitions (M&A) has been increasingly investigated in the literature in
the last two decades in response to the rise in M&A activities as well as the increasing complexity of
such transactions themselves. In this paper the definition of M&A will be used as acquisition, as the
purchase of shares or assets on another company to achieve full managerial and operational influence.
Acquiring a company abroad can be motivated by the wish of entering foreign market and establish
strong position very quickly. It enables the drawing on complementary knowledge and differing market
prospective of the acquired company and enables a realization of synergetic potentials (Epstein 2005).
However, acquiring a company is risky when the information of the targets business is beyond the
reach of acquirer and he relies on assumptions delivered by seller. At this point, an information
asymmetry occurs as the acquirer does not get reliable information about the target company to carry
out thorough evaluation and determine the price. In line with the literature, the term information risk is
used to describe the uncertainty surrounding information relevant to the acquirer’s valuations and
expectations for future economic development (Gomes et al. 2013).
The basic argument is that the firm's information environments play significant role in acquisition
decision-making. This seems logically, then the acquirer identifies and evaluates acquisition targets on
the basis of their existing knowledge and the information they gain through different information
search contexts Schildt & Laamanen, 2006). This phenomenon is explained based on the information
asymmetry phenomenon, which develops when the seller has more information than the buyer about
the goods or services to be exchanged. Acquirer identifies and evaluates the acquisition target on the
basis of existing – or from the seller signaled information. On the other side, the seller needs to signal
the necessary information; otherwise the equilibrium cannot be established.
-91-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Screening Disclosure of Signaling
Information
Due Diligence
The acquirer's lack of accurate information regarding the target limits the acquisitions as combining
companies can only occur when the information asymmetry can be managed. Hence, the acquirer needs
to accumulate information about the target firm with screening the available information. In the
acquisition process, due diligence is used to overcome the information asymmetry. The Figure 1
outlines the information flow and exchange in the context of due diligence as the tool for abolishing the
information asymmetry. Due diligence comprises of detailed investigation and risk assessment in wide
area of the targets specifications, either quantifiable or non-quantifiable. Ideally, all information is
placed in the acquisition contract which serves as the document for determining the acquisition legal
framework.
Due diligence in this research paper conforms to the learning theory, in particular the exploratory
learning, when the acquirer learns about the target firm, it’s business environment and capabilities, and
country specific aspects. Such target learning process enables the reduction of the information
asymmetry in cross-border acquisition
-92-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The purpose of the paper is to show the practical use of due diligence in the pre-acquisition phase
and link the extent of the due diligence with transaction success. The empirical evidence is done
investigating the use of due diligence in the car manufacturing industry. In the literature study where
academic and practical studies have been analyzed, the characteristic fields to be assessed in the pre-
acquisition phase are:
can lead to integration difficulties and induce further cost lowering the synergy effects (Epstein 2005,
Firstbrook 2007).
The choice of acquisition partner according to strategic and organizational fit, the compatibility of the
business capabilities and knowledge, as well as the macroeconomic factors and business environment
have led to fragmented mergers and acquisitions research separating it into large research fields. Based
on existing research streams as well the criticism of these streams, the model set up a comprehensive
framework that integrates the research fragments (Figure 2). The intention is to develop the theoretical
rationale for a comprehensive framework as well as to test the model empirically.
The dependent variable in the model is the transaction success (endogenous variable). Empirical studies
mostly research the success factors from the perspective of the acquirer’s owner or shareholder, as the
acquisition risk directly impacts the financial results and pay-out ratios. The focus of the paper is the
overall transaction success including the realization of the synergy effects and stand-alone optimization
benefits. The measurement of the variable Transaction Success is based on five different variables
(Dunne & Hodgson 2013, Epstein 2005):
− Synergy Value in Research & Development, indicating the optimization of benefits in the
technological competence due to the acquired firm
− Disposal of the acquired company indicating if the acquisition’s synergy effects have been
realized or not
− Overall Profitability indicating the quantitatively measurable value contribution of the
acquired firm
− Return on Investment indicating the linear relation of return on invested capital
− Overall Success of the acquisition is a qualitative measure indicating the acquirer’s judgment
about the firm’s either intangible or tangible contribution to combined success.
In wake of the richness of factors, the research design has been constructed with structural equation
modeling (SEM) as a multivariate data analysis method that is often used when testing theoretically
supported linear and additive causal models. The criteria for the use of PLS model, which is a variance
based model, are: small sample size with n=52, the independent variables are normally distributed
(univariate approach) and the research paper has cause-effect research character. PLS is useful for
structural equation modeling in applied research projects especially when there are limited participants
and that the data distribution is skewed and this is the case in the survey (Hair et al 2012, Sarstedt et al.
2011).
In the present research model, the inner model explains if the dependent variable performance
(Transaction Success) is influenced by the independent latent variables previously described: Strategic
and organizational fit, Business capabilities and knowledge management, Financial factors and
acquisition premium, and macro-economic factors and business environment (exogeneous variables).
However, the independent variables are not directly observable and therefore, they are explained by 19
manifest variables that have been derived from the literature review. Graphically summed up, the
research framework can be established as follows:
-94-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
The inner model consists of the four main hypothesis including elements of thorough due diligence and
the transaction success. The outer model consists of manifest and independent variables and the
dependent variables which explain the transaction success.
3. EMPIRICAL RESULTS
The empirical research was performed with questionnaire survey collecting data from a sample of
German automotive industry involved in cross-border acquisitions between 2007 and 2013 in the Central
and Eastern European region. A list of the finalized deals was compiled from the Mergermarket
Database and complemented by Thomson Financial data. The sample consists of 52 evaluated
transactions in the cross-border acquisitions. This represents ca. 34% of the full population (N= 155) in
the automotive industry and geographical region. The reliability of the survey was supplemented by pre-
testing of the questionnaire with independent industrial experts.
With SEM, the relationship between multifaceted risk factors in the due diligence and the transaction
success model is being operationalized with formative measurement model. The reliability and
predictive relevance is being judged using Stone-Geisser criteria and additionally with the coefficient
of determination. With the coefficient of determination of 0,69 and the predictive estimation with 0,35
the model shows high usefulness. Having selected the variables, the results of the relationships are
visualized in Figure 3.
The path coefficients of the constructs “Business Capabilities and Knowledge Management” and
“Macro-Factors and Business Environment” are significantly different from 0 and suggest positive
predictability characteristic for the latent variable “Transaction Success” in the structural model.
Considering the t-values, the variables “Business Capabilities and Knowledge Management” and
“Financial Factors and Acquisition Premium” have strong influence on the latent variable “Transaction
Success”. The variable “Macro-Factors and Business Environment” has a middle strong influence on the
latent variable “Transaction Success”. The construct “Choice of Strategic Partner” is non-significant and
does not have influence on the independent variable.
-95-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Figure 3 Operationalized formative measurement model with weights and loadings after bootstrapping procedure
The central proposition is that complete due diligence scope in the pre-acquisition phase is necessary to
make successful cross-border acquisition. Consequently, statistical methods of outer model analysis
and inner model analysis were utilized to test the proposition. In the framework, the main proposition,
three of four constructs were proved significant in relation to the transaction success. The significant
impact was proven in the both, the inner and outer model analysis. Summed up, the results show:
The findings support the organizational learning factor and its role in balancing information asymmetry
and suggest, the more information the firms analyzes in the pre-acquisition phase, the more better the
foundation for due diligence. In other words, the findings suggest the more the firm learns about the
target in the due diligence audit, the better will be the cross-border acquisition success.
4. CONCLUSIONS
The literature research shows no comprehensive study which considers the full range of factors to be
considered in pre-acquisition evaluation within the due diligence process. The contributed development
of a model incorporating different risk areas delivers theoretical implications in the field of risk
assessment in cross-border acquisition management. The linkage between the organizational
exploratory learning and removing information asymmetry has been proven. The results of the tested
model indicate that there is a positive relationship between successful acquisition and appropriate scope
of due diligence proceedings. The main result lies in pinpointing the specific area by which the
business capabilities and knowledge transfer build the main asset in the realization of synergy values in
the acquisition phase. In this context, the valuation of the business capabilities of the acquisition targets
can be classified as the main challenge reflecting suitability of the acquisition price.
The managerial implications are that in the pre-acquisition phase the due diligence proceedings should
selectively be audited especially in case of evaluating business knowledge capabilities. The determined
low importance of strategic, cultural and organizational fit, which is usually one of the most named
-96-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
aspects in transaction success, is indeed surprising. However, the strategic focus of the German
automotive firms is to capture capable contributor in the manufacturing chain and deepen the
technological knowledge of the overall enterprise. The motive for vertical integration of operations
along the chain value implies the exercise of market power. The cost pressure forces automotive
industry to maximize joint surplus, up and downstream of the chain value, as this maximizes its profits
and increases the competitiveness.
The tested financial issues go beyond the information provided and this will provide the basis for
forecasting future performance and identifying possible capital short falls has been supported
moderately for the German acquirers in the car manufacturing industry. The high impact of acquisition
premia on transaction success but the obvious low importance for survey participants is not logical but
supports research results from Gomes et al. (2013) conclude that acquirers tend to be driven by prices
of comparable acquisitions, rather than assessing relevant risks in the valuation and price building
phase. In line with that, the identification of the most efficient tax and legal structure is not significant
aspect for German car manufacturer. The reason lies in the financial power of the global enterprises
which can offset such potential burdens. Afterwards, such evaluated risks are reflected in the
acquisition price which help to ensure that the M&As deal intelligence gets wider scope of the risk
assessment methods and finally improve the success rates in cross-border acquisitions.
The limitation of the research is the small sample and the narrowing effect of the industry limitation.
Considering further primary data and broader sample could lead to more complex analysis,
contributing more confidence in the findings.
REFERENCES
Gleich, R., Kierans, G., & Hasselbach, T. (2009). Value in Due Diligence (216 p.). Gower Publishing.
Ahammad, M. F., & Glaister, K. W. (2013). The pre-acquisition evaluation of target firms and cross border acquisition
performance. International Business Review, pp. 1–11.
Angwin, D. (2001). Mergers and Acquisitiosn across European Borders: National Perspectives on Preacquisition Due Diligence
and the Use of Professional Advisers. Journal of World Business, 36(1), pp. 32-57.
Barkema, H. G., & Schijven, M. (2008). How Do Firms Learn to Make Acquisitions? A Review of Past Research and an Agenda
for the Future. Journal of Management, 34(3), pp. 594–634. doi:10.1177/0149206308316968
Bertrand, O., & Betschinger, M.-A. (2012). Performance of domestic and cross-border acquisitions: Empirical evidence from
Russian acquirers. Journal of Comparative Economics, 40(3), pp. 413–437. doi:10.1016/j.jce.2011.11.003
Bruner, R. F. (2004). Does M&A Pay - A Survey of Evidence for the Decision-Maker. Journal of Applied Finance, 12(1), pp. 48-
68.
Carbonara, G., & Caiazza, R. (2009). Factors Affecting M & A Success : A Starting Point for the Topic Renaissance. The Journal
of American Academy of Business, 15(September), pp. 92–99.
Dunne, P., & Hodgson, A. (2013). M & A Deal Evaluation : Challenging Metrics Myths (pp. 1–11). London.
Epstein, M. J. (2005). The Determinants and Evaluation of Merger Success. Business Horizons, 48(1), pp. 37–46.
doi:10.1016/j.bushor.2004.10.001
Firstbrook, C. (2007). Transnational Mergers and Acquisitions: How to Beat the Odds of Disaster. Journal of Business Strategy,
28(1), pp. 53–56. doi:10.1108/02756660710723215
Georgieva, D., Jandik, T., & Lee, W. Y. (2012). The impact of laws, regulations, and culture on cross-border joint ventures.
Journal of International Financial Markets, Institutions and Money, 22(4), pp. 774–795. doi:10.1016/j.intfin.2012.04.002
Gomes, E., Angwin, D. N., Weber, Y., & Tarba, S. (2013). Critical Success Factors through the Mergers and Acquisitions
Process : Revealing Pre- and Post-M & A Connections for Improved Performance. Thunderbird International Business Review,
55 (1), pp. 13–35. doi:10.1002/tie
Graham, M., Martey, E., & Yawson, A. (2008). Acquisitions from UK firms into emerging markets. Global Finance Journal,
19(1), pp. 56–71. doi:10.1016/j.gfj.2007.11.001
Hair, J. F., Ringle, C. M., & Sarstedt, M. (2011). PLS-SEM: Indeed a Silver Bullet. The Journal of Marketing Theory and
Practice, 19(2), pp. 139–152. doi:10.2753/MTP1069-6679190202
Harvey, M., Lusch, R. (1995). Expanding the Nature and Scope of Due Diligence. Journal of Business Venturing, 9026(10), pp.
5–21.
Hitt, M. a., King, D., Krishnan, H., Makri, M., Schijven, M., Shimizu, K., & Zhu, H. (2009). Mergers and acquisitions:
Overcoming pitfalls, building synergy, and creating value. Business Horizons, 52(6), pp. 523–529.
doi:10.1016/j.bushor.2009.06.008
Hopkins, H. D. (1999). Cross-border Mergers and Acquisitions: Global and Regional Perspectives. Journal of International
Management, 5(3), pp. 207–239.
Jemison, D., Sitkin, S. (1986). Corporate Acquisitions : A Process Perspective. Academy of Management, 11(1), pp. 145–163.
Knecht, F., & Calenbuhr, V. (2007). Using capital transaction due diligence to demonstrate CSR assessment in practice.
Corporate Governance, 7(4), pp. 423–433. doi:10.1108/14720700710820506
Perry, J. S., & Herd, T. J. (2004). Mergers and Acquisitions: Reducing M&A risk through improved due diligence. Strategy &
Leadership, 32(2), pp. 12–19. doi:10.1108/10878570410525089
-97-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Rossi, S., & Volpin, P. F. (2004). Cross-country determinants of mergers and acquisitions. Journal of Financial Economics,
74(2), pp. 277–304. doi:10.1016/j.jfineco.2003.10.001
Sarstedt, M., & Ringle, C. M. (2011). Multigroup Analysis in Partical Least Squares (PLS) Path Modeling: Alternative Methods
and Empirical Results. Measurement and Reasearch Methods in International Marketing, 22, pp. 195–218. doi:10.1108/S1474-
7979(2011)0000022012
Schildt & Laamanen, T. (2006). Who buys whom: Information environments and organizational boundary spanning through
acquisitions. Strategic Organization (4) pp. 111-133.
Schuler, R., & Jackson, S. (2001). HR Issues and Activities in Mergers and Acquisitions. European Management Journal, 19(3),
pp. 239–253.
Schweiger, D.M. & Very, P. (2003). Creating Value through Merger and Acquisition Integration. Advances in Mergers and
Acquisitions, 2, pp. 1-26.
Shimizu, K., Hitt, M. a, Vaidyanath, D., & Pisano, V. (2004). Theoretical foundations of cross-border mergers and acquisitions:
A review of current research and recommendations for the future. Journal of International Management, Vol. 10, pp. 307–353.
doi:10.1016/j.intman.2004.05.005
Very, P., & Schweiger, D. M. (2001). The Acquisition Process as a Learning Process : Evidence from a Study of Critical
Problems and Solutions In Domestic and Cross-Border Philippe Very. Journal of World Business, 36(1), pp. 11–31.
-98-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
The aim of our paper is to identify attributes and elements of customer satisfaction that individually and
collectively influence seniors´ evaluation of and satisfaction with retail stores and the consequent contribution
towards repeat purchase behavior or loyalty. Customer satisfaction per se refers to a set of particular attributes.
However, any single attribute of customer satisfaction (for example low prices), may not necessarily ensure
satisfaction with the store or the loyalty. Developing satisfaction with a store involves a revision in various
instruments of the marketing mix, such as product, place, price, promotion, as well as people, processes, and
physical evidence, that collectively build the resources and capabilities of a store. From marketing point of view,
customer satisfaction indicates consistently doing something valuable for customers in the way meeting their
expectations. This could influence consumers´ attitudes during their subsequent decisions and enhance repeat
purchase behavior and positive word-of-mouth communication.
The research method integrates a qualitative technique (focus group discussions) with a quantitative approach
(survey, implementing a structured questionnaire) to enhance the validity and reliability of data. Focus group of 8
participants was used to discuss and settle the construction of the scales and the content of the questionnaire. The
final version of questionnaire was distributed among 365 respondents (seniors) and consisted of 2 parts. The core
part of the questionnaire was respondents´ judgment of the importance of customer satisfaction attributes. On
a five-point scale respondents weighted all 21 attributes. Second part of the questionnaire was aimed on
satisfaction rating of individual attributes in customers´ real life. On a five-point scale participants rated their
satisfaction with individual attributes in that retail store, where they mostly purchase their grocery products. All 21
attributes have been assigned to 6 broader elements. To explain the complexity in satisfaction judgments and to
arrive at limited number of explanatory variables, factor analysis was applied to the empirical data. Factor analysis
identified three complex factors of customer satisfaction that are significant in seniors´ satisfaction with the chosen
store. They are: convenience of shopping, value for money and store image and they collectively indicate the inter-
relatedness of individual satisfaction attributes and explain the complexity of the term „satisfaction“. The findings
confirm that participants tend to compromise among individual attributes in favour of an „overall shopping
experience“, which reinforces the belief that seniors´ rating of individual satisfaction attributes should be
considered less important than that of a collective rating of satisfaction factors in judgment of shopping
satisfaction. The research in this paper was conducted within the Research project VEGA 1/0224/15.
KEYWORDS
Retail, satisfaction, marketing management, seniors.
1. INTRODUCTION
Development of customer satisfaction as a precondition of survival in a competitive market has been
discussed frequently in recent years (Nielsen, 2002; Seybold, 2001). Satisfying the customers is an
essential goal of the whole business. Companies satisfying their customers achieve better results, while
those with dissatisfied customers, fail. These findings are valid across consumer goods, services and
store selection (Giese and Cote, 2000).
Customers evaluate shopping experiences and arrive at „satisfaction judgments“ by comparing what
they really received with their expectations (Schiffman and Kanuk, 2010). This framework has been
tested many times: customers form judgments of satisfaction by comparing what they get to what they
expected (Payne, 2008). Research has confirmed that satisfaction is an important variable driving
positive word of mouth and loyalty. Loyalty as a tendency of customers to stay with a store or a brand,
is closely related to satisfaction and finally to store profitability. The dissatisfaction of consumers can
-99-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
result in negative word of mouth and lost sales. Building satisfaction is especially important in the
retail sector (Hayley and Lumbers, 2008).
Retailers develop their business in a highly competitive environment, where competitors are located
in a small distance of one another, knowing that if they do not satisfy customers wants properly, these
customers will very quickly find another store that fulfills their expectations (Oates et al., 1996).
Therefore the constant feedback from seniors´ attitudes towards the stores where they conduct their
purchasing is vital for retailers survival (Moschis, 2003).
In order to remain competitive and growing, marketers need to satisfy their customers. It has been
documented that customer satisfaction positively influences repurchase rate and loyalty (Buttle, 2004;
Huddleston et al., 2009). Cheng et al. (2011) argue that satisfying customers is more important than
short term profit goals, because as long as customers are satisfied, the business has a perspective of
profit for the future.
Several authors (Goodwin and McElwee, 1999; Lambert, 1979; Lesakova, 2013) define customer
satisfaction as the ability of an organization to provide a service performance that exceeds the customer
expectations. Deng et al. (2010) identified two types of satisfaction: the transaction specific satisfaction
and the general satisfaction. While the transaction satisfaction refers to satisfaction after completing the
purchase act, the general satisfaction describes the consumers´ overall rating. In order to satisfy
consumers, retailers need to understand the particular attributes of satisfaction, because customers can
derive satisfaction from diverse satisfaction elements (Peterson and Wilson, 1992).
Cronin et al. (2000) suggest that any evaluation of customer satisfaction that takes into account only
individual attributes, is not complete. A set of attributes provides a complex tool for explaining the
interrelated aspects of customer satisfaction in a store in terms of the whole – total experience of
satisfaction with a particular store.
-100-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Evaluation of customer satisfaction (e.g. as superior) may not necessary be based on individual
attributes that are considered in isolation (e.g. low prices that could make an impression of superior
satisfaction). A complex picture of satisfaction is derived from the collective contribution of the several
elements and attributes of customer satisfaction Although consumers obviously express their views
and comments on individual attributes of satisfaction, the collective contribution of these attributes
determines the interpretation of customer satisfaction.
Consumers´ evaluation of satisfaction (e.g. as excellent) may be the result of some special
attributes, like a combination of affordability (lower prices) and broad assortment, at the cost of store
design and layout.
Consumers value all attributes of their satisfaction with the aim to achieve a final „score“ for each
visited store. The preferred store will be the store with the highest total score. Two stores may be rated
as acceptable, although individual „scores“ for satisfaction attributes might differ significantly. In some
cases even a store with a high score will not be attractive to customers, if the most important attributes
(high price, poor design) are unacceptable. If a customer is satisfied with the overall purchase
experience, the probability of repeat purchase will increase.
staff in particular. A significant percentage indicates that friendly approach and politeness are often
disappointing.
To identify attributes and factors that are critical in terms of their contribution towards the complex
customer satisfaction, factor analysis was used. Factor analysis suggested three main factors, which
were then used for varimax rotation. An attribute loaded on a specific factor, when the loading was 0,3
or greater for that factor. Nine items loaded on the first factor, four on the second and six on the third
factor. Table 3, Table 4 and Table 5 reveal attributes and corresponding factor loadings.
The factors were named with regard to their distinct attributes. The first factor, convenience of
shopping, contains 9 attributes that can be associated with comfortable shopping and minimum
frustration. The second factor, indicating value for money, consists of four attributes that have
relevance to the financial site of the shopping and communication of the value-for-money aspect. The
third factor, store image, contains six attributes related to the quality of the products, quality of the
store and quality of the staff.
Instead of 21 partial attributes and 6 elements of customer satisfaction discussed earlier in the
paper, only these three factors were identified as crucial in terms of satisfaction judgment. Table 3,
Table 4 and Table 5 present the factor loadings.
-103-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
customer satisfaction, namely shopping convenience and value for money make a significant
contribution in terms of satisfaction.
Table 6. Pearson correlation coefficients for 3 factors of customer satisfaction versus overall customer satisfaction
Factor 1 Factor 2 Factor 3
Convenience of shopping Value for money Store image
Satisfaction 0,3109 0,3864 0,2771
<0,0001 <0,0001 <0,0001
Source: own calculation
5. CONCLUSION
The findings reveal the interactive contribution of individual attributes of shopping satisfaction to the
overall satisfaction judgment by senior shoppers. Seniors argued that the attribute „affordability“
prevents them from patronizing the stores that they are more satisfy with. Despite a dissatisfaction with
a store, seniors shop there because of „value for money“ aspect in conjunction with convenient location
of the store, which evidently negates certain unacceptable attributes. This confirms the initial
assumption that consumers criticize a certain attribute of satisfaction for a particular store when this
attribute is evaluated in isolation, but that they will nevertheless eventually shop there. Participants
tend to look for balance in terms of an „overall - complex shopping experience“ with the importance
attached to collective satisfaction of all attributes.
Three factors – namely convenience of shopping, value for money, and store image – can be
identified as crucial in terms of customer satisfaction. A significant correlation of value for money and
shopping convenience with customer satisfaction indicates the importance of affordability in
conjunction with product quality, as well as the need for an offering of additional processes,
comfortable environment, well organized store, practical shelf layout, short queues at cashiers etc.
The attributes that are used to describe the factors of customer satisfaction, that is, attributes of
shopping convenience, store image and value for money, confirm the importance of the context in
a discussion of satisfaction development in Slovak grocery retail and suggest that strategies specifically
designed for the grocery retail could be beneficial to enhance customer satisfaction.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
The research was conducted within the VEGA Project 1/0224/15 “Consumer behaviour and individual
consumption in the periods of unemployment and relative deprivation: implications for decision taking
bodies and business”.
REFERENCES
Buttle, F., 2004. Customer Relationship Management: Concepts and Tools. Elsevier Ltd., Oxford.
Clopton, S.W. et al., 2001. Salesperson Characteristics Affecting Customer Complaint Responses. Journal of
Consumer Behavior, Vol. 1 (2), pp. 124-139.
Cronin, J. et al., 2000. Assessing the Effects of Quality, Value and Customer Satisfaction on Consumer Behavioral
Intentions in Service Environments“. Journal of Retailing, Vol. 76 (2), pp. 193-218.
Deng, Z. et al., 2010. Understanding Customers Satisfaction and Loyalty: An empirical study of mobile instant
messages. International Journal of Information Management, Vol. 30, pp. 289-300.
Giese, J.L. and Cote J., A., 2000. Defining Consumer Satisfaction. Academy of Marketing Science Review, Vol
20, No.1, http://www.amsreview.org/articles/giese01-2000.pdf .
Goodwin, D. R. and McElwee, R. E., 1999. Grocery shopping and an ageing population: research note.
International Review of Retail, Distribution and Consumer Research, Vol. 9, No. 4, pp. 403-409.
Hayley, M. and Lumbers, M., 2008. Understanding older shoppers: a phenomenological investigation. Journal of
Consumer Marketing, Vol. 25, No. 5, pp. 294-301.
Huddleston, P. et al., 2009. Customer Satisfaction in Food Retailing: Comparing specialty and conventional
grocery stores. International Journal of Retail and Distribution Management, Vol. 37, No. 1, pp. 63-80.
Lambert, Z., 1979. An investigation of older consumers unmet needs and wants at the retail level. Journal of
Retailing, Vol. 55, No. 4, pp. 35-57.
Lesakova, D., 2013. Shopping decisions of senior consumers. In Mendel University Press (Ed.), Enterprise and
competitive environment (pp. 92-103). Brno, Mendel University Press.
-104-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Levy, M. and Weitz, B., 2001. Retailing Management. McGraw-Hill, New York.
Lumpkin, J.R. et al., 1985. Marketplace needs of the elderly: determinant attributes and store choice. Journal of
Retailing, Vol. 61, Summer, pp. 75-105.
Moschis, G.P., 1991. Marketing to older adults: an overview and assessment of present knowledge and practice.
The Journal of Consumer Marketing, Fall 1991, Vol. 8, No. 4, pp. 33-42.
Moschis, G., 2003. Marketing to older adults: an updated overview of present knowledge and practice. Journal of
Consumer Marketing, Vol. 20, No. 6, pp. 516-525.
Nielsen, A.C., 2002. What´s Hot around the Globe. http://www.acnielsen.com
Oates, B. et al., 1996. A psychographic study of the elderly and retail store attributes. Journal of Consumer
Marketing, Vol. 13, No. 6, pp. 14-27.
Payne, A., 2008. Achieving Excellence in Consumer Management. Elsevier Ltd., Oxford.
Peterson, R. and Wilson, W., 1992. Measuring customer satisfaction: fact and artefact. Journal of the Academy of
Marketing Science, Vol. 20, No. 1, pp. 76-89.
Seybold, P.B., 2001. Get inside the Lives of your Customers. Harvard Business Review, May, pp. 80-90.
Schiffman, L. and Kanuk, L., 2010. Customer Behaviour (10th ed.). Pearson/Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River,
NJ.
Thang, D. and Tan, B., 2002. Linking Consumer Perception to Preference of Retail Stores: An Empirical
Assessment of the Multi-Attributes of Store Image. Available at:
http://www.sciencedirect.com/journalofretailingandconsumerservice
-105-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Polish accession to the European Union resulted in loss of the use of multiple instruments hedging Polish farmers
from sudden changes in the market. An alternative to intervention or production subsidies have become initiated in
2005 with subsidized crop insurances. It should, however, be argued that these insurance do not meet the
expectations of farmers, and are not security against threats that the farmers actually fear of. Commonness, but still
restrained, was not reached until introducing the obligation to insure crops. Analysis of available statistical data
and specific provisions of the acts allows the assessment of the effectiveness of their use by farmers in Poland.
KEYWORDS
crop insurance, subsidized insurance, agriculture, compulsory insurance, famer.
Private goods Club goods Local public goods Global public goods
Competitive in Not competitive Not competitive in consumption with Not competitive in
consumption in consumption high risk of stock-out in the case of consumption, though risk
for a small group excessive number of consumers of stock-out in the case of
of users excessive number of
consumers is possible
Exclude from Limited group of It is possible to exclude others from No possibility to exclude
consumption subjects users, exclude consumption only by incurring high others from consumption
not being owners others from costs
consumption
For instance For instance For instance regional landscape, local For instance climate,
agricultural products private parks springs of drinking water biodiversity
-106-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
When discussing the character of agriculture, it needs to be stressed that agriculture has functions
which are not measurable in market terms and they result in certain limitations of the process of
decision making concerning farm management. In the theory of economy, the existence of transaction
costs is stressed (costs incurred ex ante and ex post that are connected with contract preparation and
realization). Apart from the regular production costs, these costs constitute a cost factor. A contract
preparation, costs of searching information regarding prices, costs of admonishing the other contract
party, storage costs or costs regarding protection from other parties’ claims are costs that agricultural
producers can include in the price. Yet, at the meso and macro level occur special categories of costs
which can be treated as external effects (Samuelson, Nordhaus 2006). In this situation, a producer is
forced to accept the level of incurred costs and changes of utilization function as a result of transaction
elements imposed on them by other subjects (Czternasty, Czyżewski 2007). It, therefore, constitutes the
economic dimension of realizing multifunctionality of agriculture.
This scheme illustrates only basic decision-making areas in plant production presented in the
perspective of one season. Decision whether to use land for winter or spring cultivation as well as
selection of specific grain species are basic actions taken when planning land use. Further come
decisions regarding sowing dates or performed treatments and, finally, decisions concerning plant
-107-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
protection, i.e. the need to monitor pests attacks and the occurrence of fungal diseases or conducting
soil analyses. To all that one must add economic variables regarding price forecasts of agricultural
products in the current and following year or observation of general tendencies on agricultural markets
in the future.
It is known that the socialist period of our history was very strange. In economics many decisions
depended on the acts or decisions of officials and not on the will of the entrepreneur. In agriculture and
in insurance there was similarly. In socialist period (in the of the 80's) each farmer was obliged to
participate in 11 different types of insurance. As a result, almost every farm had several types of
insurance. After the political changes most insurance obligations were abolished. We still have a lot of
farm buildings insured - because it is a compulsory insurance - and a very small number of crop
insurance.
Table 2. Changing approaches to agricultural insurance in Poland - the period of socialism and post-
Years Buildings insurance Property insurance Crop insurance (ths) Animal insurance
(ths) (ths) (ths)
Nr of Nr of Nr of Nr of Nr of Nr of Nr of Nr of
insured dameges insured dameges insured dameges insured dameges
-108-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
As it is shown in the table, the economic changes of the early '90s, farmers stopped insure their
crops. In 1988. almost 3 million farmers bought crop insurance, and in 2001 there were only 45
thousands contracts. The main reason that farmers mentioned was the fact that the prices for crop
insurance were too high.
Noticing this problem, the Polish government decided in 2005. to introduce the subsidized crop
insurance.
4.1 Reasons to initiate subsidized insurance and the obligation to enter into
agreements
In 2005 Poland introduced a legal solution which, according to the its creators, was aimed at
facilitating in the first phase of the use of state budget subsidies to insurance premiums covering
random events causing losses in plant and livestock production. The authors of this project stressed that
low ratio of insurance universality in agriculture results in the fact that in the case of unexpected
natural disasters, various aid forms for aggrieved farmers from the state budget or public finance units
are required. Additionally, the accession of Poland to the European Union precluded the use of
numerous instruments applied earlier (Łuczak 2006). An important argument supporting
implementation of this solution was, among other things, a lack of common use of crop insurance
among agricultural producers. In effect, farm owners, due to intensive occurrence of weather
phenomena, lack of insurance coverage or state support (which did not have sufficient instruments)
ceased agricultural production or engaged in non-agricultural activities.
In the course of works on this project it was emphasised that a number of conducted analyses
indicated the scale of all funds targeted at settlement of negative effects resulting from natural disasters
occurring in Poland. These funds came from the Agency for Restructuring and Modernisation of
Agriculture and were realized in the form of subsidies to interest of the so-called disaster loans (with
subsidies from state budget). However, it was pointed that these loans serve to replace farm assets and
frequently, on the basis of state experiences from 2005, were associated with drought or flood. Struck
by these type of perils, farms lose the so-called financial credibility and, as a result, cannot raise loans
targeted at farm development (for instance, purchase of additional land or new facilities). Conducted
analyses indicated that a significant part of two-year working capital disaster loans in commercial
banks is reclassified into five years. This is clear evidence that farmers have serious problems with
paying such liabilities from current receipts.
The Act of July 2005 in its material scope incorporates basic crops (grains, corn, rapeseed,
agrimony, potatoes or sugar beet) and major species of livestock (cattle, horses, sheep, goats and pigs).
-109-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Nonetheless, the further part of the present article concentrates on the scope of offered insurance
protection as well as prices used by insurance companies with respect to crop insurance and,
particularly, drought insurance.
In the primary draft of the bill, after amendments made to the scope of insured events, subsidised
insurances regarded crop protection against: hurricane, flood, torrential rain, hail, thunder, landslide,
avalanche, drought, negative effects of overwintering or spring frosts. Simultaneously, this scope was
offered only jointly, in package which meant that drought was included. However, the amendment of
2007 introduced the possibility of peril separation. It was feared that insurance companies would not be
interested in offering such a wide range of insurance services with concurrent reduction of maximum
premium collectible by insurers so that farmers retain the right to obtain subsidies.
Still, a key change introduced in that market situation was the amendment of July 2008, which
referred to the scope of obligatory insurances. Since July 2008, agricultural insurance coverage has
been compulsory for Polish farmers. Farmers have to get insurance for at least 50 percent of their
acreage, but only for crops such as: cereals, corn, rape, hop, tobacco, vegetables, fruit trees and bushes,
strawberries, potatoes, sugar beets or leguminous plants. Crops should be insured from at least one of
following risks: winterkill, spring frost, hail, drought or flood. The representatives of local authorities
(e.g. village major) could check every year that obligation in any farmer who obtained land subsidies
from EU. If this obligation doesn’t fulfill he will bear a fine of 2 Euro for 1 hectare. Additionally in
case of catastrophic damage (e.g. flood, drought) and establishing financial help for farmers, he will
obtain only half of this assistance.
Consequently, it is the producer who determines the scope of their obligatory insurance scheme,
but, on the other hand, it complicates the process of insurance adjustment since the scope of insurance
could be shaped in accordance with the actual needs of farmers, i.e. shaping individual risk construct
(Kłoczko-Gajewska, Sulewski, 2009).
Figure 5 Declaration of insurance conclusion within a specified scope
Crop insurance have significant impact on total insurance cost for every farmer. CATI research
conducted within the project unequivocally shows that in the group of subjects the most frequently
declared were insurance against spring frosts and hail. Drought insurance was declared by 22% of
subjects, with ratio of 30% among small farms. However, these data are not representative of the whole
population of farmers in Poland due to the fact that 2/3 of interviews were conducted on areas of
drought risk (Kaczała, M., Łyskawa, K, 2013). Therefore, to analyse interest in particular scopes of
crop insurance, it is recommended to use actual reports from the Ministry of Agriculture.
-110-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Agriculture and Rural Development held a special meeting for representatives of insurance companies
(PIU comittee on agricultural insurance), officials from the Department of Finance at the Ministry of
Agriculture and scientists from the Institute of Soil Science and Plant Cultivation (pl. IUNG) and the
Institute of Geodesy and Cartography. Definition suggested by IUNG was accepted by all participants
and was reflected in the Act:‘the occurence of decreased climatic water balance below values
determined for particular crop plant species and soils in any six-decade period from April 1 to
September 30’.
Yet, the need to further clarifying provisions in detail and specify particular types of crops was
emphasised, especially in the light of changing material scope of the Act where subsidy would
incorporate further types of field cultivations (for instance, vegetables, fruit, hops). Also, IUNG was
obliged to create historical digital drought maps on the basis of available data that would allow insurers
to examine regional diversification of this phenomenon’s occurrence. However, insurance companies
highlighted the fact that this method is new and in reference to phenomena occurring in the past does
not allow to verify correctly the assumed model.
In addition, the state offered insurers support in financing compensation claims for losses caused by
drought. This support involves subsidies in the case when paid compensation claims exceed 90% of
drought insurance premiums. Also, insurance companies are entitled to partial coverage of
compensations amounting to 60% of compensation claims over the specified limit.
Table 2. The amount of claims paid in subsidized insurance of the risks (2008-2012) in Euro.
Type of
2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013
event
YEARLY
AVERAGE
3,5166 4,3273 3,9946 4,1198 4,185 4,1975
RATES
PLN/Euro:
44 882
Drought 313 625,12 151 282,23 524 232,97 27 772,28 9 332,70
019,28
Flood 86 545,81 362 275,78 1 092 130,63 459 879,12 258 401,43 404 465,75
-112-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
REFERENCES
Samuelson P.A., Nordhaus W.D., 2013, Ekonomia, Rebis, Poznań
Czternasty W., Czyżewski B., 2007, Struktury kierowania agrobiznesem w Polsce, Wydawnictwo Akademii
Ekonomicznej w Poznaniu, Poznań
Handschke J., Kaczała M., Łyskawa K., 2015, Koncepcja polis indeksowych i możliwość ich zastosowania w
systemie obowiązkowych dotowanych ubezpieczeń upraw w Polsce, Uniwersytet Ekonomiczny w Poznaniu,
Warszawa
Łuczak P., Co i na jak długo zostało ze wsparcia krajowego?, „Top Agrar Polska”, nr 3/2006.
Kłoczko-Gajewska, A., Sulewski, P., 2009, Postawy rolników wobec ryzyka oraz sposoby jego ograniczania.
Series G–Economy Vol. 96–No., 141.
Janowicz-Lomott, M., Łyskawa, K., 2014, The new instruments of risk management in agriculture in the European
Union. Procedia Economics and Finance, 9, 321-330.
Kaczała, M., Łyskawa, K, 2013,. Factors affecting the demand for index-based agriculture insurance in Poland.
Insurance Review, Wiadomości Ubezpieczeniowe no.4, p. 75-92
European Network for Rural Development, 2009, Dobra publiczne i publiczny system interwencji – raport
analityczny: Paneuropejski przegląd podejścia państw członkowskich do dostarczania środowiskowych i
-113-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
społecznych dóbr publicznych w programach Rozwoju Obszarów Wiejskich na lata 2007–2013, 2009,
http://ksow.pl/fileadmin/user_upload/ksow.pl/pliki/ANALIZY_ekspertyzy/Raport_Dobra_Publiczne.pdf
(access: 15.07.2012).
TNS Polska, Badanie zainteresowania ubezpieczeniem od suszy. Raport z badań ilościowych przygotowany dla
Uniwersytetu Ekonomicznego w Poznaniu, Poznań, 2012.
Rojewski, K. 2012 Historia i stan obecny ubezpieczeń rolnych w Polsce
http://piu.org.pl/public/upload/ibrowser/Mnrd%20Konf%20Rolna/1%20Historia%20i%20stan%20obecny%20
ubezpiecze%C5%84%20rolnych%20w%20Polsce%20-%20K.pdf (access: 16.06.2015)
-114-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Today, information technologies are changing constantly and rapidly. In parallel with this, business organizations
must develop and optimize their business processes to gain competitive advantage. It can easily be said that IT
units of most business organizations spend most of their time in correcting the errors affecting the user’s work
negatively and in the changing of the IT components causing these problems. In general, the number of errors and
the problems detected by IT or the number of necessary changes exceed its capacity. Therefore determining which
methods will be used in the use of resources is of great importance. In today's technology it can easily be seen that
web-based applications are becoming widespread. The main reason for that is that web-based applications have
caught up with the form-based applications and can offer strong results in its own favor. In today's systems where
electronic transactions are being popularized, the execution of a paper-based project causes different problems. A
desktop business tracking program named Order Development Management (ODM) is being used in the SAP
department of the firm Schneider-Electric. ODM program has some disadvantages. The aim is to use this tool more
effectively to decrease the loss of time, to reduce the risk of the documents’ being damaged and lost, to prevent the
failure in business processes by developing new extensions. In this study, a new web-based application called
“request development management system (RDMS)” has been designed and carried out to perform the purposes
mentioned.
KEYWORDS
Work Tracking System, Web Applications, DOM, RDMS, PHP, HTML5
1. INTRODUCTION
As an updated perspective, information technologies (BT) have several components; such as computer
equipment, computer software, computer networks, communication technologies, specialized
manpower, procedures, internet, intranet and communication tools. In this sense, information
technologies have become a term composed of a series of technologies and tools which are “creating
value and adding value”. In the past, information technologies were used to be known as control and
management tool, but now it is playing the most significant role in making strategic decisions and
reaching the correct data.
From now on, directors of corporations need to use information technologies effectively for evaluating
numerous informations coming from differenf sources, making decisions and implementing decisions
in a short time. For this reason, it should be possessed of a good organisation and strategy to define
requirements properly and developing correct solutions.
In today’s technology, it is seen that web based applications are gradually becoming widespread. The
main factors of this are increasing speed of access in time, increasing security on web based
applications and web-based applications offer strong results.
This study is composed of three sections. In the first section, terms of information, data and
informatics, in the second section, decision support systems have been examined. In the third section,
lacking side of current desktop application and solution suggestions for these lacks were mentioned,
-115-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
and the purpose, scope and method of developed application were mentioned. The study was
completed by evaluating the obtained results.
-116-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Figure 1. Andrew P. Sage. Decision Support Systems Engineering. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York,1991
Within the current research, many works are focused on developing DSS in a combination with
appropriate operations research methodologies to improve cost efficiency and achieve greater
flexibility in industrial management (Tarantilis et al., 2005; Repoussis et al., 2009). DSS literature
comprises two main streams: data-based DSS, dependent on data mining to derive decision rules, and
model-based DSS, reliant on optimization, simulation, heuristic, and statistical models (Hand et al.,
2001; Pearl, 2000; Loebbecke and Huyskens, 2009).
Decision support systems allow people at many levels to systematically analyze problems before
making a decision. In the process, these systems extend the range and capability of the decision-making
process, increasing its effectiveness (Gallegos,1999). Marakas describes the common characteristics of
DSS as listed at below (Marakas,2003).
• Employed in semi structured or unstructured decision contexts
• Intended to support decision makers rather than replace them
• Supports all phases of the decision-making process
• Focuses on effectiveness of the process rather than efficiency
• Uses underlying data and models
• Facilitates learning on the part of the decision maker
• Is interactive and user-friendly
• Is generally developed using an evolutionary, iterative process
• Can support multiple independent or interdependent decisions
• Supports individual, group or team-based decision-making
5. APPLICATION
-117-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Schneider Electric company, has developed and implemented a new software due to lack of current
software being used.
New software has been developed to overcome these problems which has listed above, should be
handled in a project.
-118-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
moved to using the four web programming languages and web environment with desktop software is
provided for use in a more efficient manner. Flow chart of a project shown in Figure 2.
6. CONCLUSIONS
Given that the right decision to obtain a competitive advantage against the competition with increased
productivity. In this study, a decision support system aimed at improving efficiency has been designed
and developed. Thus, the desktop application DOM, where using in Schneider Electric SAP
department, moved to web environment and also provided the opportunity to access the system from
locations located in countries other than Turkey. Problems experienced in the previous program has
-119-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
been corrected and increased the managers ability to make their decisions with more consistent data
were obtained for in the department.
The benefits received by the program can be listed as follows:
• The occurrence of any changes relating to the work done is provided by the report screen.
• Authentication mechanism was created. Thus, it can be followed which user made which changes
now.
• Duplicate records were prevented to occur.
• Accessing to the system facilities by other users in your business are provided (if desired).
• Abroad SAP Schneider Electric employees are provided to make tracking work through the
system.
In summary, due to the mentioned problems, working as a desktop study of this software, web based
development as proposed and started to work in this direction. Adding new application authentication
system and reporting screens to eliminate the problem is to assist managers in decision-making it easier
for them to decide. Developed a web-based system development life cycle by working more on the
later times of the RDMS program in principle; automatic e-mail feature, the approval mechanism, an e-
mail alert system, work time, language preference, global project and so features new plug-ins and for
inclusion in the necessary work are recommended. Developing with this add-on may increase the
effectiveness of the software
REFERENCES
Arslan, V., Yılmaz, G. 2010. “Karar Destek Sistemlerinin Kullanımı İçin Uygun Bir Model Geliştirilmesi”,
Havacılık Ve Uzay Teknolojileri Dergisi Temuz 2010 Cilt:4 Sayı:4 (75-82)
Atılgan, D. 2004. “Bilgi Yönetimi Kavramı Ve Gelişimi”, Türk Kütüphaneciliği 23, 1 (2009), 201-212, 2009
Bellınger, Gene; Castro, Durval, Mılls, Anthony; “Data, Information, Knowledge And Wisdom”
Gallegos, F. 1999. Decision Support Systems: An Overview. Information Technology, 15(2), Pp. 42-46.
Gorry, G.A. And Scott Morton, M. 1971. A Framework For Management Information Systems. Sloan
Management Review 13(1):50-70.
Güçlü, N., Sotırofskı, K. 2006. “Bilgi Yönetimi”, Türk Eğitim Bilimleri Dergisi Güz 2006, 4(4), 351-371
Hand, D.J., Mannila, H. And Smyth, P. 2001. Principles Of Data Mining, Mit Press, Cambridge.
İraz, R. 2005. “İşletmelerde Bilgi Yönetiminin Yenilik Verekabet Gücü Üzerindeki Etkileri”, Selçuk Üniversitesi
İktisadi Ve İdari Bilimler Dergisi, Cilt:19 Sayı:1
İşevi, A. S., Çelme, B. 2012. “Bilgi Çağında Yeni Hazine: Entellektüel Sermayeyle Rekabeti Yakalamak”, I. Ünak
Genel Konferansı Ünak 2012 19 Mayıs Üniversitesi
Kanehısa, M., Goto, S., Sato, Y., Kawashıma, M., Furumıchı, M. And Tanabe, M. 2014. “Data, Informatin,
Knowledge And Principle: Back To Metabolism İn Kegg”, Nucleic Acids Research, 2014, Vol. 42, Database İssue
D199-D205
Koçoğlu, E. 2010. İşletmelerde Yöneticilerin Karar Verme Süreci Ve Bu Süreçte Bilişim Sistemlerinin Kullanımı :
Ankara İli Örneği, Atılım Üniversitesi Sosyal Bilimler Enstitüsü, Yüksek Lisans Tezi
Marakas, G.M. 2003. Decision Support Systems. Prentice-Hall Publishing, 2nd Edition.
Özcan, B. 2006. Yönetim Bilişim Sistemleriyle İşletmelerde Değer Yaratılması , Yıldız Teknik Üniversitesi Sosyal
Bilimler Enstitüsü, Yüksek Lisans Tezi, 2006
Özdemirci, F., Aydın, C. 2007 “Kurumsal Bilgi Kaynakları Ve Bilgi Yönetimi”, Türk Kütüphaneciliği 21, 2
(2007), 164-185
Tarantilis, C.D., Spinellis, D. And Gendreau, M. 2005. “Advanced Heuristics In Transportation And Logistics”,
Ieee Intelligent Systems, Vol. 20 No. 4, Pp. 16-18.
Yılmaz, M. 2009. “Enformasyon Ve Bilgi Kavramları Bağlamında Enformasyon Yönetimi Ve Bilgi Yönetimi”,
Ankara Üniversitesi Dil Ve Tarih-Coğrafya Fakültesi Dergisi 49, 1 (2009) 95-118, 2009
-120-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Nowadays interest in corporate environmental strategies has shifted from cleaner processes to green products. The
relevant literature of "Porter Hypothesis", argues firms have the opportunity to pioneer through green products'
innovation, allowing them to differentiate and thus gain competitive advantage. On the other hand, products'
environmental burden during entire lifecycle is undeniable. Yet, bearing in mind the weakness of previous work to
adequately address a commonly accepted green product definition, as well as the inconclusive academic empirical
results on firms' competitiveness, there were many cases of corporations' green-washing behavior that come as no
surprise.
In this exploratory paper we proceed with an exhaustive literature review, aiming to fill the gap of terminology
absence. We develop an integrative concept that regards green product from "cradle to grave" and provides a
combinatory framework for defining and evaluating the degree to which a product / procedure contributes to social
and environmental sustainability.
KEYWORDS
Green products and procedures, social and environmental sustainability
1. INTRODUCTION
Nowadays multidimensional crisis calls for simultaneous economic stability, social equity and
environmental protection pushing firms to actively engage and complete their "corporate social
responsibility". Dynamic relationship between firms and environment has undergone progressive
change (De Bakker et al., 2002). In the 1960s and 1970s, environmental problems were basically
neglected from firms, while in the 1980s biophysical environment - seen as an externality and thus
additional cost - led some businesses to simple compliance with end-of-pipe technologies. Until then,
the majority of US-products did not incorporate environmentally friendly characteristics with the
exception of organic foods in the food industry (Air Quality Sciences, 2010). After the publication of
Brundtland Report in 1987 with the alongside emergence of “sustainable development” terminology,
the 1990s were marked by the revolutionary approach of "Porter Hypothesis" (De Bakker et al., 2002;
Berry & Randinelli, 1998). According to Porter and van der Linde (1995), environmental innovation as
response to ecological challenges may offer multiple competitive opportunities that stem from
differentiate and/ or cost strategies, in a win-win logic.
Since then, “green” became a hot topic in academia and there has been a growing number of
references regarding terms such as “green products”, “green strategies”, “green labeling” and so on
(Air Quality Sciences, 2010). The problem is that every term including the notion “green” /
“environmental” seems to totter and be quite complex. So, the correct definition should be the starting
point. That is the reason why we turn to the very basics: what is finally a “green product”?
Main objective of this work is to identify works on the field of “green product” definition and
thereafter to see the progress that has been made in theoretical as well as empirical studies concerning
the relationship “green vs. competitiveness” in the last years. The exhaustive literature review seems to
be the necessary methodological approach helping to the conceptual content of the field and guiding us
-121-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
towards proper theory development, in an attempt to establish a functional term in order to fill the
existing gap.
The rest of the paper is structured as follows: next section presents the environmental management
literature review, in which we see the transition from “green processes” to “green products”. Section 3
provides the theoretical background of the field, in order to help us define clearly the concept “green
product” through relevant terminology. In the forth section we explore the debate on the empirical
studies concerning “green vs. competitive”. Last but not least, section 5 summarizes this study and
provides conclusions and proposals for further research.
2. ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT
The emergence of environmental management that cares for coordinating organizations with
environment, arose in order to minimize the ongoing and conspicuous environmental degradation,
caused by the prolonged industrial production and is traced in the 1990s (Chen, 2008; Lee, 2009). It
became quite fashionable since the new millennium and concepts such as “green management”, “green
innovation”, “environmental strategies” have come to the forefront and have been widely researched
(Chen, 2008; Orsato, 2006). Although there is no common classification among the forces that
motivated businesses’ sensitiveness and led to the acquaintance of environmental management, two of
them seem to be mainly addressed in the literature: the stringency of environmental legitimacy, which
took place in international and national scale and the rise of consumerism (Wong, 2012).
Firstly taken strategies of corporate environmental management have started to go beyond
regulatory compliance - an approach that flourished since 1960s - as the continuous emergence and
adjustment of environmental laws led to increased costs (Ross & Evans, 2002; Tien et al., 2005). At
that time the existing corporate environmental management focused on reactive strategies. Later on, the
shift that took place was from end-of-pipe pollution control technologies (e.g. filters) to corporate
environmental management of environmental proactivity (Charter et al., 2001).
These proactive strategies are distinguished in organizational and operational/ functional, with the
later to further divide in process oriented and product oriented strategies (González Benito & González
Benito, 2006). At first, the focus was on cleaner production processes, aiming at reduction of impacts
through a more environmentally conscious production process (González Benito & González Benito,
2006; Frondel et al., 2007).
The progressive change that followed, next to cleaning production technologies and pollution
prevention, caused the environmental management to entail forms of product stewardship (De Bakker
et al., 2002). Over the last decades, corporations' shift towards proactive environmental protection
strategies shifted from processes to products due to stringent environmental regulations that aim at
minimizing the ecological footprint of products since there has been the understanding that products
can create an environmental burden during their whole lifecycle, from production to consumption and
finally to disposal (Albino et al., 2009; Boons 2002; Triebswetter & Wackerbauer, 2008). According to
Wong (2012), the “green product” innovation seemed to be more influential than “green process”
innovation. Moreover, there are major markets for eco-products that require businesses’ full
compliance (Wong, 2012).
Nowadays, it has been perfectly clear that economic growth should be accompanied by
minimization of ecological degradation as well as attention to social problems. Thus, an increasing
number of companies are working on the development of environmentally friendly products that will
function as a differentiation tool, aiming at competitiveness (Chen, 2013). Consequently, concepts such
as integrated environmental management (Margerum, 1999), integrated product policy (Commission of
the European Communities, 2001), product-oriented environmental management (De Bakker et al.
2002), environmental design (Tien et al., 2005), green supply-chain management (Shrivastava, 2007),
green product design (Chan, 2011), green product development (Jasti et al., 2015), design for the
environment (Us term) / eco-design (European term) / environmental conscious design (Bauman et al.,
2002; Van Weenen, 1995; Tukker et al., 2015), green product innovation (Wong, 2012) and product
stewardship (De Bakker et al., 2002) have come to the forefront and are researched in academia, while
at the same time have led to the development of new methodologies for the evaluation of
environmental impacts such as Life Cycle Analysis, Strategic Environmental Assessment,
Environmental Management Systems and many more (Albino et al., 2009; Bauman et al., 2002; De
Bakker et al. 2002; Finnveden et al. 2009).
-122-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
green products, for they all use up energy and resources and create by-products and emissions during
their manufacture, transport to warehouses and stores, usage, and eventual disposal. So green is
relative, describing products with less impact on the environment than their alternatives”. The term of
course falls short because it does not incorporate the intangible (services) together with the tangible
(physical) which would represent a significant increase in scope and is too long. On the other hand, the
OECD (1998) term according to which “environmental goods and services include all activities that
measure, prevent, limit, minimize or correct environmental damage” does not refer to products effect
from “cradle to grave” (Fankhauser et al., 2013).
The right definition should interpret the boundaries of the concept clearly so that it will constitute
the foundation for valid inferences. The main goal is the contribution to the conceptual understanding
by harmonizing the different terms to a general that could be implemented in all fields. Thus the term
must be short but at the same time exhaustive and inclusive. Thus the following laconic concept could
be proposed: green is a product/ service that minimizes its environmental impact during its whole life-
cycle.
5. CONCLUSION
Concluding, there has been a shift in corporations’ interest to “green products” over the years. Hitherto
literature review though still seems to be inconclusive in theoretical investigation. Despite the
development on the field, there exists a terminology gap maybe due to the fact that the field is
considered relatively new. Our effort was to contribute to this discussion by providing a laconic yet
inclusive term in order to fulfill this gap in literature. Finally, there is an ongoing debate in empirical
investigation as well.
Last but not least, on a further research there should be a list of the environmental and economic
variables as well as of the techniques that have been used in past researches in order to find the most
suitable and objective ones and then move to a thorough empirical investigation to examine the
relationship “green vs. competitive”. That would be of course quite challenging, since the majority
seems to be based in questionnaire surveys (Chen et al., 2006; Triebswetter & Wackerbauer, 2008) and
would require suitable data. Lastly, since the majority of empirical examination focuses on the US
economy (Darnall et al., 2008) it would be of great interest to focus on European Union.
REFERENCES
-124-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Air Quality Sciences, Inc., 2010. Defining Green Products. Retrieved from
http://www.cleanlink.com/pdf/casestudieswhitepapers/Defining_Green_Products.pdf
Albino V. et al, 2009. Environmental strategies and green product development: an overview on
sustainability driven companies. Business Strategy and the Environment, Vol. 18, No. 2, pp. 83-96.
Baumann H. et al, 2002. Mapping the green product development field: engineering, policy and
business perspectives. Journal of Cleaner Production, Vol. 10, No. 5, pp. 409-425.
Berry, M. A. and Rondinelli, D. A., 1998. Proactive corporate environmental management: A new
industrial revolution. The Academy of Management Executive, Vol. 12, No. 2, pp. 38-50.
Boons, F., 2002. Greening products: a framework for product chain management. Journal of Cleaner
Production, Vol. 10, No 5, pp. 495-505.
Chan, H. K., 2011. Green process and product design in practice. Procedia-Social and Behavioral
Sciences, Vol. 25, pp. 398-402.
Charter, M. et al, 2001. Integrated product policy and eco-product development. Sustainable Solutions–
Developing Products and Services for the Future, Greenleaf Publishing, Sheffield, pp. 98-117.
Chen, Y. S., 1991. The economic impacts of green product development. Retrieved from
http://dspace.mit.edu/bitstream/handle/1721.1/35382/30962445.pdf?sequence=1
Chen, Y. S. et al, 2006. The influence of green innovation performance on corporate advantage in
Taiwan. Journal of business ethics, Vol. 67, No. 4, pp. 331-339.
Chen, Y. S., 2008. The driver of green innovation and green image–green core competence. Journal of
Business Ethics, Vol. 81, No. 3, pp. 531-543.
Chen, Y. S. and Chang, C. H., 2013. Greenwash and green trust: The mediation effects of green
consumer confusion and green perceived risk. Journal of Business Ethics, Vol. 114, No 3, pp. 489-
500.
Commission of the European Communities, 2001. Green Paper on Integrated Product Policy, Retrieved
from
http://www.ab.gov.tr/files/ardb/evt/1_avrupa_birligi/1_6_raporlar/1_2_green_papers/com2001_gre
en_paper_on_integrated_product_policy.pdf
Costantini, V. and Mazzanti, M., 2012. On the green and innovative side of trade competitiveness? The
impact of environmental policies and innovation on EU exports. Research Policy, Vol. 41, No. 1,
pp. 132-153.
Darnall, N. et al, 2008. Do environmental management systems improve business performance in an
international setting?. Journal of International Management, Vol. 14, No. 4, pp. 364-376.
De Bakker, F. G. et al, 2002. Organizing product-oriented environmental management from a firm’s
perspective. Journal of Cleaner Production, Vol. 10, No. 5, pp. 455-464.
Durif, F. et al, 2010. In search of a green product definition. Innovative Marketing, Vol. 6, No. 1, pp.
25-33.
Fankhauser, S. et al, 2013. Who will win the green race? In search of environmental competitiveness
and innovation. Global Environmental Change, Vol. 23, No. 5, pp. 902-913.
Finnveden, G. et al, 2009. Recent developments in life cycle assessment. Journal of environmental
management, Vol. 91, No. 1, pp. 1-21.
Frondel, M. et al, 2007. End of pipe or cleaner production? An empirical comparison of environmental
innovation decisions across OECD countries. Business Strategy and the Environment, Vol. 16, No.
8, pp. 571-584.
González Benito, J. and González Benito, Ó., 2006. A review of determinant factors of environmental
proactivity. Business strategy and the environment, Vol. 15, No. 2, pp. 87-102.
Hartmann, P. and Apaolaza Ibáñez, V., 2006. Green value added. Marketing Intelligence &
Planning, Vol. 24, No. 7, pp. 673-680.
Horváthová, E. 2010. Does environmental performance affect financial performance? A meta-
analysis. Ecological Economics, Vol. 70, No. 1, pp. 52-59.
Jasti, N. V. K. et al, 2015. Development of a framework for green product
development. Benchmarking: An International Journal, Vol. 22, No. 3.
Kam-Sing Wong, S., 2012. The influence of green product competitiveness on the success of green
product innovation: Empirical evidence from the Chinese electrical and electronics
industry. European Journal of Innovation Management, Vol. 15, No. 4, pp. 468-490.
-125-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Lee, K. H., 2009. Why and how to adopt green management into business organizations? The case
study of Korean SMEs in manufacturing industry. Management Decision, Vol. 47, No. 7, pp. 1101-
1121.
López-Gamero, M. D. et al, 2009. The whole relationship between environmental variables and firm
performance: Competitive advantage and firm resources as mediator variables. Journal of
environmental management, Vol. 90, No. 10, pp. 3110-3121.
Margerum, R. D., 1999. Integrated environmental management: the foundations for successful
practice. Environmental management, Vol. 24, No. 2, pp.151-166.
Ottman, J. and Books, N. B., 1998. Green marketing: opportunity for innovation. The Journal of
Sustainable Product Design, 60.
Pickett-Baker, J. and Ozaki, R., 2008. Pro-environmental products: marketing influence on consumer
purchase decision. Journal of consumer marketing, Vol. 25, No. 5, pp. 281-293.
Porter, M. E. and Van der Linde, C., 1995. Toward a new conception of the environment-
competitiveness relationship. The journal of economic perspectives, Vol. 9, No. 4, pp. 97-118
Rennings, K., 2000. Redefining innovation—eco-innovation research and the contribution from
ecological economics. Ecological economics, Vol. 32, No. 2, pp. 319-332.
Ross, S. and Evans, D., 2002. Use of life cycle assessment in environmental
management. Environmental Management, Vol. 29, No. 1, pp. 132-142.
Saha, M. and Darnton, G., 2005. Green Companies or Green Conpanies: Are Companies Really Green,
or Are They Pretending to Be?. Business and Society Review, Vol. 110, No. 2, pp. 117-157.
Srivastava, S. K., 2007. Green supply chain management: a state of the art literature
review. International journal of management reviews, Vol. 9, No. 1, pp. 53-80.
Stark, J., 2011. Product lifecycle management. pp. 1-16. Springer London.
Tien, S. W. et al, 2005. An empirical study on the correlation between environmental design
implementation and business competitive advantages in Taiwan's industries. Technovation, Vol. 25,
No. 7, pp. 783-794.
Tukker, A. et al, 2001. Eco-design: the state of implementation in Europe–conclusions of a state of the
art study for IPTS. The Journal of Sustainable Product Design, Vol. 1, No. 3, pp. 147-161.
Yanarella, E. J. et al. 2009. Research and Solutions:" Green" vs. Sustainability: From Semantics to
Enlightenment. Sustainability: The Journal of Record, Vol. 2, No. 5, pp. 296-302.
Van Weenen, J. C., 1995. Towards sustainable product development. Journal of Cleaner
Production, Vol. 3, No. 1, pp. 95-100.
Wahid, N. A. and Lee, T. T., 2011. Product, process and combined green innovations on firm’s
competitive advantages. Elixir International Journal, Vol. 38, pp. 4330-4334.
-126-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Corruption is considered by the vast majority of researchers and policymakers as one of the primary obstacles to
economic growth. At the same time, the most corrupt countries have remained at a stable level of corruption for
decades, showing limited or no progress in fighting the evil. Why is corruption so persistent if it brings such
negative outcomes for a country? A growing body of literature has investigated the different mechanisms that lead
to these outcomes. The persistence of corruption might reflect some natural equilibrium in the society, in which
being corrupt is the natural way of doing business. Such a value-based culture of corruption might be inherent in
the everyday culture of a society as a social norm. In addition, corruption may have rational social and/or
institutional roots that have persisted for a long time. Social capital, for example, might not always produce
positive externalities and may in fact lead to corrupt behavior.
This paper investigates the relationship between social capital and corruption within the business community in
Ukraine. It explores how the strategies that businesses employ to build trustful relationships with their peers might
contribute to their perception of and involvement in corruption. The authors hypothesize that building trust by
formalizing trustful relationships (via building reputations, using middlemen, etc.) might be conducive to creating
a less corrupt business practices. And, in contrast, building trust by informalizing trustful relationships (via using
connections, giving presents or making family friends, etc.) might lead to more corrupt business practices.
The empirical analysis is based on a representative survey of Ukrainian companies, which was conducted in spring
2013 and describes a wide range of firm characteristics together with questions related to corruption and trust
perception, among other things.
In order to test the hypotheses, the authors introduce and estimate artificial measures for a firm’s perception of
corruption and the formal and informal ways that firms can build trustful relationships with their business partners.
These measures are derived from a principal component analysis based on specific questions from the survey
related to corruption and trust perception among firms. Alternative measures are estimated in order to verify
robustness. Regression-based empirical analysis indicates that there is no significant relationship between a firm’s
practice of formal methods of trust building and its perceived corruption; at the same time, however, the authors
find a significant positive relationship between a firm’s practice of informal methods of trust building and its
perceived corruption related to their business operations. The relationship is robust with regard to different
measures of perceived corruption and the inclusion of other explanatory variables. Additionally, the authors find a
weak positive relationship between a firm’s age and its perceived corruption. The results indicate that firms
functioning on the B2C market are less inclined to corrupt behavior. At the same time, there is no indication that
firm size and integration into international markets relate in any way to a firm’s corrupt or informal practices in
doing business. Interestingly, the results indicate a strong negative relationship between the size of the city where a
firm operates and its perceived corruption.
KEYWORDS
Corruption, trust, informal and formal relationships, Ukraine
1. INTRODUCTION
Corruption24 is considered by the vast majority of researchers and policymakers as a primary obstacle
to economic growth, posing significant risks for investors and/or increasing inequality (Rose-
24
Transparency International defines corruption as ‘the abuse of entrusted power for private gain’. Private gain is
usually understood not only in a financial sense, but also in a sense of status or influence (cf. Ledeneva 2009: 258).
-127-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Ackerman, 1978; North, 1990; Gupta, Davoodi, & Alonso-Terme, 2002). At the same time, the most
corrupt countries have remained at the same level of corruption for decades, showing limited or no
progress in fighting the evil (Mauro, 2002; Mishra, 2006; Warren & Laufer, 2010). What limited data
is available on corruption in Ukraine indicates its stunning persistence. Transparency International’s
corruption perception index (Figure 1) shows little movement either in terms of the score or the
percentage of countries that are above Ukraine on that study25.
Figure 1. Corruption Perception Index and Percentage of Countries with Higher Index Scores than Ukraine
3 1
0.9
2.5
0.8
0.7
2
0.6
1.5 0.5
0.4
1
0.3
0.2
0.5
0.1
0 0
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
Corruption perception index Percentage (right scale)
In the same vein, trust and trustworthiness as components of social capital are closely related to
corruption. Vertical (institutional) trust is usually seen as a prerequisite for compliance with the law,
leading to a decrease in corruption. Analyzing Russia, Wintrobe (2001) argues that if people do not
believe the government they will attempt to evade their taxes; reflexively, if people assume others are
trying to evade their taxes they will attempt it themselves. Similarly, Svendsen (2003) descries the
vicious circle of corruption that leads to a lower level of trust and hence a slowdown of economic
growth that, in turn, increases the centralization of state power and leads to even more corruption. The
influence of horizontal trust (generalized trust, trust in other people) on corruption is ambiguous. On
the one hand, a high level of trust in others reduces the transaction costs; this lead to an increase of
aggregate benefits that leaves no room for corruption (Putnam, 1993). Indeed, Bjørnskov (2003) shows
that the direction of influence proceeds from trust to corruption; that is, an increase of trust in one’s
fellow citizens causes less corruption with weak reverse causality. On the other hand, trust within a
family or an informal network can lead to increased parochial corruption by reducing the enforcement
problem that arises when two parties are involved in a bribe transaction (Kingston, 2007). We find
support for such a case in a great deal of anecdotal evidence from Ukraine and other post-Soviet
countries, where many companies become members of closed clubs or membership organizations like
charitable funds in order to assist in tax evasion and/or reduce authority control. The ambiguity of the
relationship between trust and corruption in Ukraine is reflected in Neutze and Karatnycky (2007).
They indicate a mixed picture of corruption practices in the private sector in Ukraine. While corruption
remains a major mechanism by which companies evade taxes, obtain market access and favorable or
even monopolistic conditions and resolve complicated bureaucratic procedures, many big companies
strive for transparency, as precondition for trust, in order to get access to the international capital
market. At the same time, small and medium-sized enterprises strive for a decrease in negative, blat-
related trust in order to have equal access to corruption. In the same vein, when describing a post-
Communist society like Russia or Ukraine, Rose (1999) classifies social capital networks that are based
on market norms and formal relations between economic agents as modern, and those that rely on
informal relations and connections to get things done outside the rules as anti-modern. In order to carry
out business activities in such a society, entrepreneurs usually combine both modern and anti-modern
market approaches. On the interpersonal level, Ledeneva (1998) points to blat as a widespread informal
exchange system based on interpersonal trust that people use to solve their everyday problems26 in the
countries of the former Soviet Union. A similar trust-based system of exchange of favors, called
“compadrazgo”, exists in Chile (Adler & Sheinbaum 2004).
Thus, it turns out that the ways in which businesses build trustful relationships with their peers
might contribute to their perception of and involvement in corruption. In this paper, we hypothesize
that, within the business community, building trust by formalizing trustful relationships (via
establishing reputations, using middlemen, etc.) might be conducive to creating a less corrupt business
practices. And, in contrast, building trust by informalizing trustful relationships (via using connections,
giving presents or making family friends, etc.) might lead to more corrupt business practices.
Indeed, Tanzi (1995) distincts arm’s-length vs. close relationships in a society, where latter is more
conducive to the spread of corruption. He mentions that corruption within formal, arm’s-length
relationships would clearly reflect unwarranted and anti-social behavior that is easy to identify and,
hence, punish. On the other hand, close informal relationships would make corruption more frequent,
hidden or even invisible, making punishment much more problematic and possibly leasing to the
spread of corruption. Similarly, Putnam (2000) admits that social capital, like any other form of capital,
can be conducive to anti-social purposes. He distinguishes between two forms of social capital:
bridging (or inclusive) capital, which links individuals from different social groups; and bonding (or
exclusive) capital, which builds strong ties between individuals within the same social group. He points
out that bonding social capital might not always have a positive societal effect. Harris (2007) develops
on this, showing empirically that a high level of bonding social capital, which is characterized by a
high level of particularized trust and reciprocity amongst families and close friends, increases
corruption. Although there is no strict relation between our distinction of formal and informal practices
of building trustful relationships and Putnam’s bridging and bonding social capital, by definition,
bonding social capital is characterized by strong in-group loyalty and reciprocity, which is often is built
via informal relations. This provides additional support for our hypotheses.
In order to test the hypotheses, we introduce and estimate artificial scales to measure a firm’s
perception of corruption and the formal and informal ways that firms can build trustful relationships
26
While Ledeneva mostly refers to Russia, blat is inherited from the Soviet era; hence, it is typical for most post-
Soviet countries.
-129-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
with their business partners. Our analysis is based on a representative business survey of Ukrainian
companies, which was conducted in spring 2013 and describes a wide range of firm characteristics
together with questions related to corruption and trust perception, among other things. We add to the
empirical literature on corruption by showing a positive relationship between respondents’ practices of
trust building with peers via informal connections and their perceived corruption related to their
business operations.
The rest of this paper is organized as follows: Section 2 introduces the data, outlines some
descriptive statistics, the measurement of our main variables and an estimation strategy. Section 3
presents the estimation results and discussion. Section 4 concludes.
Selecting vendors/contractors/winners of
Cronyism, Nepotism, Lobbying 2.37 1.24 530
open tenders on the basis of informal
relationships and agreements
27
The Public Administration sector was excluded from this survey.
-130-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Receiving
fees kickbacks or other material
Gift, Conflict of Interest 1.67 1.01 524
benefits from job candidates
It should be noted that a firm’s perception of corruption and informal practices is not a clear and
direct indication of that firm’s experience with and/or involvement in corrupt practices. However, the
spread of the perception of corruption among firms may indeed cause a spread of corruption via a self-
fulfilling prophesy mechanism. For example, based on the data from 30 West and East European
countries, Frey and Torgler (2007) show that the spread of corruption in terms of tax evasion increases
if taxpayers perceive that tax evasion is widespread. Therefore, here we assume that a firm’s high
perception of corruption indicates the degree of that firm’s involvement in business corruption.
The frequencies of the firms’ practice of formal and informal methods of building trustful
relationships are derived from the firms’ answers to the block of questions shown in the Table 2.
Table 2. Firms’ Practices of Formal and Informal Strategies of Building Trustful Relationships. Question: How
often do you practice the following strategies for establishing trust with your partner? (scale from 1 – never to 5 –
always)
‘Formal’ Strategies
‘Informal’ Strate-
gies factor
component factor
coefficients,
Strategies Mean St.dev coefficients,
% variance
% variance
explained: 33%
explained: 21%
We count practices (1), (3) and (5) as representing strategies of formal trustful relationship building,
while practices (2), (4), (6) and (7) represent strategies of informal trustful relationship building.
Interestingly, such a division was supported by the Principal Component Analysis (PCA) using the
Varimax with Kaiser Normalization rotation method. It revealed two principal components with the
same division of firms on formal and informal practices of building trustful relationships28. The last
two columns of Table 2 present the factor coefficients from PCA that were used as weights to construct
two artificial measures - indices of a firm’s practice of formal and informal methods of trustful
28
The results remain unchanged when we used a simple mean of responses to corresponding questions to form
additive indices.
-131-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
relationship building29. A higher value for each index indicates higher reliance of a firm on either
formal or informal strategies of building relations with potential partners.
We use regression analysis to investigate our hypotheses on how firms’ practice of formal and
informal methods of relations building relate to the usage of corrupt, informal practices in doing
business. The direction of causality from trust to corruption is widely discussed in the literature. Harris
(2007) provides theoretical considerations of such relationship, showing both direct and indirect effects
from bonding social capital (trust) to corruption. Bjørnskov (2003) shows the same direction of
causality from generalized trust to corruption by employing both the principal-agent theoretical model
and empirical estimations. At the same time, Uslaner (2001) and Bjørnskov (2003) report weak
evidence of the reverse causality. Hence, our estimation model can be written as follows:
Corri = α + βTrust _ reli + γX i + ui ,
Here, Corr denotes our proxy of firms’ corruptness measured via a level of perceived corruption of
firms. As mentioned above, for the sake of robustness, we use two alternative measures of perceived
corruption by calculating the average of the responses to the corresponding questions from the Table 1
and by forming weighted indices using factor coefficients from PCA. Trust_rel denotes two variables -
the measures of the frequency with which firms apply formal (the variable: Formal relations) and
informal (the variable: Informal relations) methods for building trustful relationships, derived from
PCA as described above. X represents other factors that are likely to influence the firms’ perception of
corruption; u is the error term. The other factors we consider that might influence firms’ perception of
as well as participation in corruption are the following: Ownership structure (domestic ownership = 1,
foreign ownership or joint venture = 0), we expect that exclusively domestic ownership may be
conducive to corruption and/or informal practices; type of firm’s business model (Business-to-
Customer model (B2C) = 1, Business-to-Business model (B2B) = 0) and firm’s size (measured by
actual number of employees) – we expect that firms functioning on the B2C market as well as big firms
are more open and pay more attention to their reputation, hence, are less inclined to corrupt/informal
practices; year of firm establishment – we expect a positive relationship between a firm’s age and its
practice of corrupt/informal behavior30; the size of the city where firm operates (two dummies: regional
(oblast) capital31, and provincial city with less than 50 thousand inhabitants with the reference group -
provincial city with more than 50 thousand inhabitants). In order to capture a firm’s perceived
corruption in relation to the extent of its integration into international markets, we include as
explanatory variables the share of products/services sold on the domestic market (the variable: %
products/services sold domestically) and the share of products/services bought on the domestic market
(the variable: % products/services bought domestically). We also use firms’ income for the last year
reported (six dummy variables for seven income categories) and regional dummies (24 dummy
variables for 24 oblasts and the Republic of Crimea)32 as control variables.
Table 3 outlines the descriptive statistics of the data we use.
Corr_average (average from the scale from 1 – never to 443 1 5 1.91 0.89
5 – systematically)
Formal relations (average from the scale from 1 – never 625 1 5 2.98 0.85
to 5 – always)
Informal relations (average from the scale from 1 – 625 1 4.75 1.90 0.76
never to 5 – always)
Year of firm establishment 624 1930 2013 1995 17
29
A reliability analysis of these two indices shows a high reliability of the informal practices index (Cronbach’s
alpha = 0.72) and a weak reliability of the formal practices index (Cronbach’s alpha = 0.49).
30
We base this assumption on the fact that the longer a firm is in business, the more chances it has to internalize its
business practices and to establish informal connections with its partners.
31
The smallest regional capital population is 117,000; the largest 2,814,000 people.
32
The six-region division of Ukraine on Western region (Lviv, Ternopil, Ivano-Frankivsk Volyn , Rivne,
Chernivtsi, Zakarpattia), Northern region (Zhytomyr, Chernihiv, Kyiv, Sumy), Central region (Khmelnitskiy,
Vinnytsa, Cherkassy, Poltava, Kirovohrad), Southern region (Odessa, Kherson, Mykolaiv, Crimea), Eastern
region (Dnipropetrovsk, Zaporizhzhia, Kharkiv) and Donbas region (Donetsk, Luhansk) was used for robustness
check and revealed similar estimation results not reported here.
-132-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Provincial city with less than 50 thousand inhabitants, 625 0 1 0.2 0.4
dummy
Domestic ownership, dummy 625 0 1 0.92 0.27
3. ESTIMATION RESULTS
The results of the Ordinary Least Squares regression estimation are presented in the Table 4. We use
three different specifications of the base model. Model (1) only employs the explanatory variables on
firm’s practice of building relations with partners. While Model (2) additionally uses the variables on
firm’s age, firm’s size and firm’s location (big city, small city) that might be count as strictly
exogenous and/or they define long-term strategy of a firm. Finally, Model (3) employs all the variables
from the survey that are likely to influence the firm’s corruptness including income and regional
control variables.
All specifications show a significant positive relationship between a firm’s practice of informal
methods of building trustful relations and its systematic usage of corrupt/informal practices in doing
business measured by its perceived corruption. The relationship is robust with regard to different
measures of perceived corruption and the inclusion of different explanatory variables. At the same
time, we found no relationship between a firm’s practice of formal methods of building trustful
relationships and its systematic usage of corrupt/informal practices in doing business measured by its
perceived corruption.
The inclusion of different explanatory variables presents us additional interesting results. The
results show a weak positive relationship between a firm’s age and its perceived corruption33. As we
supposed and estimation results reveal those firms functioning on the B2C market are less inclined to
corrupt behavior. There is no indication that firm size and integration into international markets relate
in any way to a firm’s informal/corrupt practices. Interestingly, the results show a strong negative
relationship between the size of the city where a firm operates and its informal business practices. It
appears that firms operating in small cities are less involved in corrupt informal practices than firms
from bigger cities. One possible explanation of this phenomenon might be in the fact that the firms in
small cities are more visible and, hence, pay more attention to their reputation, which discourages them
from becoming involved in corrupt/informal practices.
Table 4. Regression estimation results
Corr_averag Corr_factor Corr_averag Corr_factor Corr_averag Corr_factor
Dependent variable
e e e
Model (1) Model (2) Model (3)
Constant -1.90*** -0.01 9.98* 9.50* 6.47 5.54
(0.04) (0.05) (5.13) (5.73) (5.20) (5.80)
-0.01 -0.01 -0.31 -0.31 -0.02 -0.02
Formal relations
(0.04) (-0.05) (0.04) (0.05) (0.04) (0.05)
0.25*** 0.28*** 0.26*** 0.29*** 0.20*** 0.22***
Informal relations
(0.04) (0.05 ) (0.04) (0.05) (0.05) (0.05)
Year of firm -0.004 -0.005* -0.002 -0.002
establishment (0.003) (0.003) (0.003) (0.003)
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
Number of employees
(0.00) (0.00) (0.00) (0.00)
City with less than 50 -0.23* -0.27* -0.31*** -0.35***
000 inhabitants, dummy (0.13) (0.14) (0.12) (0.13)
33
That is, the smaller is firm’s year of establishment the higher is its perceived corruption.
-133-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
It is worth mentioning the limitation of this study that comes from possible endogeneity problem.
Indeed, using of the kind of survey data we use in this study does not allow to fully accounting for
endogenetity. The inclusion of a series of potentially confounding variables and obtaining robust
estimate for the variable of interest together with the findings of other researches of the topic who
report causal connection that goes from trust to corruption and not the other way around (Uslaner,
2004; Bjørnskov, 2003 and Harris 2007) allow us to consider limited exposure to the problem in our
case.
Also, it is important to note that the measure of informal methods of building trustful relations and
the measure of corrupt practices both include such item as gift giving in their measurement. The lists of
items to include in calculation of both measures were based on the interviews with managers of
Ukrainian companies who mentioned gift-giving as a part of Ukrainian culture and, at the same time, as
possible informal/corrupt practice used for keeping close relations with a partner. This makes not a big
surprise to get a strong positive correlation between these measures. In order to avoid having common
factor for both dependent and independent variables we re-estimated all the specifications with a new
dependent variable calculated from the reduced list of items in the Table 1, not including the gift-giving
items, using the same methodology as for the original dependent variable(s) (Corr_average or
Corr_factor). The results of such estimation do not differ considerably from the stated results and all
the conclusions remaining valid.
4. CONCLUSIONS
The persistence of corruption in a country might have different reasons. It may come from cultural root
of a society and/or from some specific social/institutional mechanisms. Social capital is one of them.
There is widespread agreement about the importance of social capital for economic growth; at the same
time, the literature is ambiguous when it comes to explaining the effect of social capital on corruption.
Based on the data from business survey in Ukraine, the paper explores the relationship between firms’
practices of establishing trustful relations with their partners and their perceived corruption that is used
as a proxy of firms’ involvement in corrupt/informal practices.
This paper has shown that the ways in which firms build trustful relationships with their partners
matter for the persistence of business corruption in the case of Ukraine. Building trustful relationships
based on informality leads to a higher level of perceived corruption, which itself might increase actual
business corruption. The policy implications from these results suggest an increasing role of
government, the business community and business schools in directing the business community toward
the formalization of business relationships.
-134-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
REFERENCES
Adler, L. & Sheinbaum, D., 2004. Trust, Social Networks and the Informal Economy: A Comparative
Analysis. Review of Sociology, 10(1): 5-26.
Barr, A. & Serra, D., 2010. Corruption and Culture: An Experimental Analysis. Journal of Public
Economics, 94(11-12): 862-869.
Bjørnskov, Ch., 2003. Corruption and Social Capital. Aarhus School of Business Working paper 03-13.
Corruption in Ukraine. Comparative Analysis of National Surveys: 2007–2009, 2011, Kyiv
http://uniter.org.ua/upload/files/PDF_files/Publications/corruption_in_ukraine_2007-2009_2011_engl.pdf,
(accessed 7 January 2015).
Denisova-Schmidt, E. & Huber, M., 2014. Regional Differences in Perceived Corruption among Ukrainian
firms. Eurasian Geography and Economics, 55(1): 10-36.
Frey, B. & Torgler, B., 2007. Tax Morale and Conditional Cooperation. Journal of Comparative
Economics 35: 136-159.
Gupta, S. Et al., 2002. Does Corruption Affect Income Inequality and Poverty? Economics of Governance,
3(1): 23-45.
Harris, D., 2007. Bonding Social Capital and Corruption: A Cross-National Empirical Analysis. University
of Cambridge, Department of Land Economics, Environmental Economy and Policy Research Working Papers
01/2007.
Kingstone, C., 2007. Parochial Corruption. Journal of Economic Behavior & Organization, 63: 73-87.
Ledeneva, A. 1998. Russia’s Economy of Favours: Blat, Networking and Informal Exchange. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Ledeneva, A., 2009. From Russia with Blat: Can Informal Networks Help Modernize Russia? Social
Research, 76(1): 257-288.
Mishra, A., 2006. Persistence of Corruption: Some Theoretical Perspectives. World Development, 34(2):
349-358.
Neutze, J. & Karatnycky, A., 2007. Corruption, Democracy and Investment in Ukraine, Atlantic Council
Transatlantic Relations Papers http://www.atlanticcouncil.org/publications/reports/corruption-democracy-and-
investment-in-ukraine, (accessed 7 January 2015).
North, D.C., 1990. Institutions, Institutional Change, and Economic Performance. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press.
Paolo M., 2002. The Persistence of Corruption and Slow Economic Growth, IMF Working Papers 02/213,
International Monetary Fund.
Putnam, R.D., 1993. Making Democracy Work: Civic Traditions in Modern Italy. Princeton University
Press, Princeton.
Putnam, R. D., 2000, Bowling Alone: The Collapse and Revival of American Community, Simon &
Schuster, New York/London.
Rose-Ackerman, S., 1978. Corruption: A Study in Political Economy. New York: Academic Press.
Rose, R. 1999., Getting things done in an antimodern society: social capital networks in Russia. In
Dasgupta, P. & and Serageldin, I. (eds.) Social Capital. A Multifaceted Perspective. 147-171. Washington, D.C.:
The World Bank.
Shekshnia, S. et al., 2013. Reflective Leadership vs. Endemic Corruption in Emerging Markets. INSEAD
Working Paper 2013/121/EFE. Fontainebleau: INSEAD.
Shekshnia, S. et al., 2014. How to Mitigate Corruption in Emerging Markets: The Case of Russia. Edmond
J. Safra Working Papers, paper No. 36. Cambridge, MA: Edmond J. Safra Center for Ethics, Harvard University.
Svendsen, G., 2003. Social Capital, Corruption and Economic Growth: Eastern and Western Europe.
Aarhus School of Business Working paper 03-21.
Tanzi, V., 1995. Corruption: arms-length relationships and markets. In The Economics of Organised
Crime, (eds.) Fiorentini, G., Peltzman, S. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge.
Uslaner, E.M. 2004, ‘Trust and Corruption’, In Corruption and the New Institutional Economics, (eds.)
Lambsdorf, J.G., Taube, M. and Schramm, M., Routledge, London.
Warren, D. & Laufer W., 2009. Are Corruption Indices a Self-Fulfilling Prophecy? A Social Labeling
Perspective of Corruption. Journal of Business Ethics, 88(4): 841-849.
Warren, M.E., 2004. Social Capital and Corruption, Democracy and Society, Spring 2004: 1, 16-18,
http://www.democracyandsociety.com/blog/wp-content/uploads/2009/12/DSSpring2004.pdf, (accessed 7 January
2015).
Wintrobe, R., 2001. Tax Evasion and Trust. University of Western Ontario, Department of Economics
Working Paper 200111.
-135-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
E-gambling is nowadays one of the fastest growing sectors of e-commerce. Every day even more individuals are
moving from terrestrial to online gambling venues and wagering through numerous playing options. Consequently,
the dynamics of this e-commerce activity has forced various researchers and practitioners to investigate e-
gambling area from different perspectives trying to gain an improved insight into the behavior in the cyberspace.
The purpose of the present paper is to examine an underexplored area of e-gambling behavior; that is the
compound and situational characteristics of e-gamblers. Based on extant literature a proposed conceptual
framework is developed and analyzed through factor analyses and stepwise regression analyses. The empirical
results presented are believed to provide useful insights to both academia and the gambling industry.
KEYWORDS
e-gambling, e-gambling behavior, e-business, compound characteristics, situational characteristics
1. INTRODUCTION
Internet gambling, also known as online gambling or electronic gambling can be defined as the
procedure of laying bets of real money over the Internet. It characterizes all forms of wagering via the
World Wide Web through varied media including computers, wireless devices, such as mobile phones
& tablets, and interactive television (Wood & Williams, 2011). Beginning in the early 1990s, when the
Internet access expanded into private residences and workplaces, it introduced a novel area of betting
opportunities to terrestrial gamblers and potential participants. Therefore, any form of traditional
gambling soon appeared in its electronic format and have since been easily reached to any person with
an Internet connection and means of electronically transferring money (Wood & Williams, 2011). Skill
games, such as poker and blackjack, lucky games, such as slot machines roulette, sports betting, as well
as many other e-gambling games have been widely available providing plentiful e-gambling features
and playing options.
E-gambling, nowadays, is a highly profitable business with numerous e-business models varied
from enterprises offering pure gambling choices to others providing relevant information, such as odds
and payout rates. By 2015 the global internet gambling gross market is expected to exceed US$43
billion (Global Betting and Gaming Consultants, 2011; Holliday, 2011) growing at a rate of about 12%
per annum; and represent a critical sector (around 9%) of the gambling market (Global Betting and
Gaming Consultants, 2010; Kelleher, 2010; PricewaterhouseCoopers, 2011). It is also characterized as
one of the fastest growing sectors of e-commerce.
Given the continuing growth and the dynamics of this particular type of e-business activity, a
comprehensive understanding of e-gambling has become a pursuit of various researchers, as well as
many practitioners. Thus, several studies have been carried out in the e-gambling field from different
perspectives trying to gain an improved insight into consumer behavior in cyberspace (Griffiths, 2009).
The purpose of this paper is to examine the consumer behavior of e-gamblers focusing on their
compound and situational characteristics. The extant literature on segmentation emphasizes the
importance of employing both behavioural and attitudinal variables for segmenting and targeting
customers (Phillips et al., 2004; Hawkins & Mothersbaugh, 2009; Rundle-Thiele & Bennett, 2001).
Increased competition in the gaming industry has resulted in the need for gambling companies to
-136-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
identify consumer segments and target customers with a view to establishing appropriate
communication strategies and tactics.
Until recently, this scientific approach of e-gambling has been slightly investigated. By
understanding e-gamblers’ behavior and involvement patterns, the relevant e-business models as well
as potential e-gambling ventures would be able to more successfully segment the market and
incorporate suitable marketing strategies, moderate gamblers’ concerns, structure right enticements in
order to keep the e-players in the game and convince even more people to gamble online. Furthermore,
they would make it possible to persuade current e-gamblers to increase the amount of money spent.
The rest of the paper is organized as follows: in the first section, the literature review and
hypotheses development are presented; this is followed by the methodology and the results of the
survey whereas the last section concludes with the implications of the study, its limitations and
directions for future research.
-137-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Competitiveness (CO)
Impulsiveness (IM)
Numeric Interest (NI)
Present Time Orientation (PTO)
E-Gambling
SITUATIONAL Behavioral
CHARACTERISTICS Intention (BI)
Money (MO)
Socialization (SO)
Escape (ES)
Excitement (EX)
2.1.2 Impulsiveness
Mowen (2000) added impulsiveness as a construct on its 3M model because of human’s direct reaction
in various every day situation. Regarding e-gambling, the majority of its forms elicit an impulsive
feature. Thus, e-gambling enterprises are greatly based on individuals’ impulse after a win or loss in a
betting event. Especially in a defeating situation, an individual’s prompt reaction is to try to get back
what he/ she owned. Additionally, e-marketers regularly place online advertisements about gambling
games in various websites where an impulsive act may occur. For example, e-gambling advertisements
are extremely common in websites with sports content. Fang & Mowen (2009) suggested that
impulsiveness has a positive impact on sports betting, slot machines and promotional gambling games.
Therefore, based on the above literature, the following hypothesis can be formulated:
mathematical and numerical skills in order to increase winning chances. Additionally, gambling
regularly involves using numbers to calculate odds and how much can be won or lost. Thus, the
importance of numeric interest in e-gamblers participation has driven us to include it as a construct in
the proposed conceptual framework. Concerning previous studies, Fang & Mowen (2009) claimed that
the interest in numeric information has a positive impact on skilled card games. Thus, regarding the
behavioural intention towards e-gambling, it is hypothesized that:
H4. Present time orientation has a positive effect on e-gambling behavioural intention.
2.2.1 Money
The basic feature of individuals’ e-gambling participation is to win, that is to make money. Humans are
greatly lured by the various e-gambling features and playing options. Thus, they participate in order to
have a financial gain. Various studies, such as Gibson & Sanbonmatsu (2004) and Cotte (1997),
suggest that one important motive for gambling is to make money. Fang & Mowen (2009) stated that
gambling for money has a positive impact on skilled games and sports betting. Based on this literature
review, the money construct is added to the proposed conceptual framework. Thus, it is reasonable to
hypothesize that:
H5. E-gamble for money has a positive effect on participants’ behavioural intention.
2.2.2 Socialization
The second situational characteristic included to the proposed conceptual framework is socialization.
There are many e-gambling games in which humans meet each other in e-platforms in order to
participate in e-gambling events. Neighbors et al. (2002) identified as a gambling motive to be with
friends and socialize with others. Furthermore, humans’ interactions with each other in the real world
might be attributed to their e-gambling activity. For example, many sports betting e-gamblers make
friends through e-business models which they visit in order to get informed about relevant information,
such as odds and payout rates. According to Fang & Mowen (2009), the gambling motive of
socialization takes place in skilled games and sports betting. Therefore, regarding the behavioural
intention towards e-gambling, it is hypothesized that:
H6. E-gamble for socialization has a positive effect on participants’ behavioural intention.
2.2.3 Escape
The relative prevalence of problem gambling among e-gamblers is a serious situation that takes place
worldwide. According to Wood & Williams (2011), a total of 16.4% of e-gamblers are either moderate
or severe problem gamblers, compared to a rate of only 5.7% among terrestrial gamblers. There are
-139-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
numerous factors that influence them negatively (e.g., family environment, friends, poor school
achievement, etc.). According to Neighbors et al. (2002), people might gamble in order to escape their
troubles and problems and cope with depression and anxiety. Characteristically, Fang & Mowen (2009)
approved that the gambling motive for escape takes place in slot machines. Thus, it is likely for
someone to try to find alternatives in order to forget and/ or run away from his/ her troubles and
problems. Based on the aforementioned issues, the escape construct is added to the proposed
conceptual framework. Therefore, it is hypothesized that:
H7. E-gamble for escape has a positive effect on participants’ behavioural intention.
2.2.4 Excitement
The last examined situational characteristic is gambling for excitement. There are many people who
resort to e-gambling games for having fun and entertaining themselves. For example, a vital goal of
casinos is to build a highly pleasant environment where humans will have a good time. They count on
the atmosphere provided in order to attract gamblers. Fang & Mowen (2009) suggested that many
gamblers participate in skilled games and slot machines for excitement. Thus, regarding the
behavioural intention towards e-gambling, it is reasonable to hypothesize that:
H8. E-gamble for excitement has a positive effect on participants’ behavioural intention.
All the hypotheses formed above, are summarized in Table 1.
Fang & Mowen, 2009). A pilot study using a sample of fifteen responses helped to identify possible
problems in terms of clarity and accuracy. Thus, comments and feedback from respondents improved
the final presentation of the items. Twenty-two participants gave incomplete answers and their results
were dropped out. As a result, the final sample consisted of 80 respondents who gamble online. The
demographic characteristics of the sample are: 56.3% are male and 43.7% are female; 70% have at
least some college education; and 55% of the respondents were between 18 and 24 years old. As can be
seen, the sample is fairly young and more educated than the general public; been in accordance with
previous studies (e.g., Wood & Williams, 2011). Schema 1 presents the flow of the survey design.
Sampling Population to
Time horizon
design be studied
Data collection
Data analysis Results
method
Factor analysis was applied to test the validity of the variables, classify and reduce questions into sub-
variables when possible, and calculate factor loadings. Specifically, the principal component analysis
(PCA) using orthogonal rotation (VARIMAX) was firstly performed to assess the underlying structure
of the data. The PCA method is particularly suited to summarize the most of the original information
-141-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
(variance) in a minimun number of factors for prediction purposes (Hair et al., 2006). Orthogonal
extraction, using VARIMAX rotation, was suited for research goals and the need to reduce a large
number of variables to a smaller set of uncorrelated variables. Additionally, VARIMAX rotation
attempts to minimise the number of variables that have high loadings on a factor, and, hence, enhance
the interpretability of the factors (Hair et al., 2006).
Nevertheless, in order to test the appropriateness of the data for factor analysis, several measures
were applied to the entire population matrix. More specifically, Bartlett’s tests of sphericity (p = 0.000)
in both factor analyses confirmed the statistical probability that the correlation matrix has significant
correlations among the variables, whereas the results of Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin (KMO) measure of
sampling adequacy were 0.703 and 0.726, which are meritorious. Additionally, the measures of
sampling adequacy (MSA) values all exceed 0.50 for both the overall tests and each individual variable
(Hair et al., 2006). All the aforementioned measures indicated the suitabily of factor analysis in both
compound and situational items.
By applying the Kaiser eigenvalues criterion, five factors extracted to both factor analyses that
collectively explained 68.613% and 74.587% of the variance in all items correspondingly. Regarding
construct validity, which testifies how well the results obtained by the use of the measure fit the
theories on the basis of which the test is designed (Crabbe et al., 2009), it was tested by the use of two
broadly applied tests, convergent and discriminant validity. In detail, “convergent validity is
demonstrated if the items load strongly (>0.50) on their associated factors, whereas discriminant
validity is achieved if each item loads stronger on its associated factor than on any other factor” (Hair
et al., 2006). Tables 4 and 5 show that all items have loadings greater than 0.50 and load stronger on
their associated factors than on other factors. Thus, convergent and discriminant validity are
demonstrated. All the factors proved to be relatively easy to interpret, owing to the strong variable
loadings. Finally, construct reliability was assessed using Cronbach’s alpha. Tables 4 and 5 also show
that values ranged from 0.729 to 0.865, which is in accordance to the generally agreed upon lower limit
for Cronbach’s alpha of 0.70 (Hair et al., 2006).
Constructs/ Factors
Cronb
a = 0.865 a = 0.763 a = 0.785 a = 0.740 a = 0.729
ach’s
-142-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
alpha
Constructs/ Factors
Behavioural
Items Socialization Excitement Escape Money
Intention
Factors BI IM CO PTO NI
BI 1
IM 0.247** 1
CO 0.302** 0.444** 1
PTO 0.299** 0.367** 0.294** 1
NI 0.304** 0.315** 0.395** 0.308** 1
** p = 0.001
A stepwise regression analysis was conducted to assess the best predictors among the independent
compound variables believed to have an impact on e-gambling behavioural intention. Additionally, it
revealed which of the four hypotheses were supported. According to Hair et al. (2006), stepwise
regression is considered as the most popular sequential approach to variable selection. The results
presented in Table 5 indicate that 13.9% of the variance in e-gambling behavioural intention is
explained by two predictors in the model. Numeric interest has the highest explanatory value of 9.2%
(b = 0.21, t = 2.107, p = 0.038), followed by present time orientation 4.7% (b = 0.231, t = 2.046, p =
0.044). From the four compound hypotheses only two, namely H3 and H4 (the impact of numeric
interest and present time orientation towards e-gambling behavioural intention), were supported.
-143-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Table 5: Compound results of the stepwise regression analysis for behavioural intention towards e-gambling
Factors BI MO SO EX ES
BI 1
MO 0.288** 1
SO 0.184** 0.048** 1
EX 0.403** 0.516** 0.263** 1
ES 0.310** 0.120** 0.422** 0.470** 1
** p = 0.001
Thus, a stepwise regression analysis was conducted to assess the best predictors among the
independent situational variables believed to impact on e-gambling behavioural intention. Additionally,
it revealed which of the four hypotheses were supported. The results presented in Table 7 indicate that
16.2% of the variance in e-gambling behavioural intention is explained by one predictor in the model;
e-gambling for excitement (b = 0.403, t = 3.865, p = 0.000). Therefore, from the four situational
hypotheses only one, namely H8, was supported.
Figure 2 depicts the final formation of the proposed conceptual framework.
Table 7: Situational results of the stepwise regression analysis for behavioural intention towards e-gambling
-144-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
COMPOUND
CHARACTERISTICS
E-Gambling
SITUATIONAL Behavioral
CHARACTERISTICS Intention (BI)
Excitement (EX)
4. CONCLUSION
The present paper comprises the first part of a research in progress which aims to shed light on the
broad topic of e-gambling. More specifically, its main scope was to investigate the compound and
situational characteristics of the individuals involved. The research findings are believed to provide
interesting implications to both academia and practicing managers. The theoretical and managerial
implications, as well as the survey’s limitations and its future research directions are described as
follows.
Various researchers and practitioners have investigated e-gambling from different perspectives trying
to gain an improved insight into e-gambling behavior in cyberspace. As a step forward, this paper
encompasses a number of studies and examines the compound and situational characteristics of e-
gamblers based on the 3M model proposed by Mowen (2000). As far as it is concerned, there is an
extremely limited research on gambling behavior which has utilized the trait categories of the 3M
model. Thus, the paper examines an underexplored area and its results are believed to help the
academia by providing new inferences and insights on e-gamblers’ compound and situational
characteristics that affect their behavioural intention. To our knowledge, the impact of some
characteristics examined and the non-significance of some others are believed to be vital for the
academic community. Therefore, concerning the theoretical implications, the paper is expected to set
the groundwork for further scientific research and improvement.
In addition, practising managers and marketers are anticipated to get a benefit from the results
drawn in the present study. More specifically, the survey results can help them better evaluate their e-
gambling ventures and their online and digital forms and follow analogous e-business strategies in
order to adjust their e-structures with a view to offer playful experiences, satisfying not only the current
customers’ desire to e-gamble, but also to attract prospective online gaming customers who have
preferred the traditional way of gambling so far. Additionally, by understanding the e-gamblers’
behavior, the relevant websites would enable to incorporate suitable marketing campaigns, moderate
gamblers’ concerns and apart from convincing even more people to be transferred from offline to
online gambling, persuade current e-gamblers to increase the amount of money spent on e-gambling
games. The specific e-gamblers’ preferences and motivations discussed in the present research are
crucial to marketers’ designing more effective, user-centered, promotional strategies for targeting and
retaining e-gambles. To clarify, the influence of numeric interest and present time orientation on e-
gambling behavioural intention can be interpreted in various ways from the industry. Since many
-145-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
people involved in gambling judge the level of risk in terms of frequencies than probabilities in
percentage formats (Roller, 2011), gamble sites, in order to offer attractive win/lose ratios, could be
modified on number formats and presentations accordingly. In addition, more marketers should place
greater emphasis on the importance of time perspective in their communication strategies as regards the
present- oriented e-gamblers. On the other hand, the non-significance of impulsiveness and
competitiveness is believed to alter some long established thoughts and cliché about their influence on
e-gambling. Commonly, as regards the situational characteristics, the impact of excitement and the
non-impact of money, socialization and escape are expected to undeniably modify current e-gambling
standpoints. Online casino owners could make online games more exciting by combining critical
ingredients of the e-casino related to the situational (i.e. sounds, colors, luminosity ) and structural
characteristics of the actual online games being played (i.e. intermittent schedules for reward and loss,
near-misses especially in games of skill and choice opportunities). According to Ahmad et al. (2010),
understanding and predicting consumer behavior is a critical feature in marketing and a necessary
requirement for firms which are marketing oriented, thus, profitable, as it underpins all marketing
activities pursued by them. Alternatively, practising managers who are willing to invest in an e-
gambling business model, could use the survey results as a consulting tool while organizing their work
and implementing their e-business ideas.
To sum up, it is believed that the present survey can add value to aspects involving both the
academia and the gambling industry, as it provides useful insights concerning the behavior of e-
gamblers and their attitude towards e-gambling. Therefore, the results can be interpreted through
various customized approaches.
Despite the fact that the results provide meaningful implications, there are three limitations in the
present research. First, it is restricted to a small sample of respondents; thus, it did not enable more
advanced statistical methods for data analysis, such as Structural Equation Modeling (SEM).
Furthermore, the small sample forced the researchers to analyze the data of the compound and
situational characteristics in separate factor and regression analyses. Consequently, the utilization of
SEM, which aims at developing a proposed model, would certainly offer a more holistic view and may
provide additional important insights to the scientific community and practicing managers as well.
Second, the sample is comprised of people who are fairly young and more educated than the general
public. Therefore, the specific sample characteristics bias the results and merit further investigation.
Third, as only the compound and situational characteristics of the 3M model were studied, it is required
that all four levels of the 3M model be investigated so that further information could be provided to
both the academia and the gambling industry.
REFERENCES
Aasved, M. 2003. The Sociology of Gambling. Charles C. Thomas, Springfield, IL, USA.
Arnord, J. M. and Reynolds, E. K. 2009. Affect and retail shopping behavior: Understanding the role of mood
regulation and regulatory focus. Journal of Retailing, Vol. 85, No. 3, pp. 308-320.
Cattell, R. B. 1978. The scientific use of factor analysis in behavioral and life sciences. Plenum, New York, USA.
Cotte, J. 1997. Chances, trances, and lots of slots: Gambling motives and consumption experiences. Journal of
Leisure Research, Vol. 29, No. 4, pp. 380-406.
Cotte, J. and Latour, K. 2009. Blackjack in the kitchen: Understanding online versus casino gambling. Journal of
Consumer Research, Vol. 35, pp. 742–758.
Crabbe, M., Standing, C. and Standing, S. 2009. An adoption model for mobile banking in Ghana. International
Journal of Mobile Communications, Vol. 7, No. 5, pp. 515-543.
El-Kasheir, D., Ashour, A. and Yacout, O. 2009. Factors Affecting Continued Usage of Internet Banking Among
Egyptian Customers. Communications of the IBIMA, Vol. 9, pp. 252-263.
-146-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Eysenck, S. B. and Eysenck, H. J. 1977. The place of impulsiveness in a dimensional system of personality
description. British Journal of Clinical Psychology, Vol. 16, pp. 57-68.
Eysenck, S.B. and Eysenck, H.J. 1978. Impulsiveness and venturesomeness: their position in a dimensional system
of personality description. Psychological Reports, Vol. 43, pp. 1247-1255.
Fang, X. and Mowen, C. J. 2009. Examining the trait and functional motive antecedents of four gambling
activities: slot machines, skilled card games, sports betting, and promotional games. Journal of Consumer
Marketing, Vol. 26, No. 2, pp. 121-131.
Gibson, B. and Sanbonmatsu, D. M. 2004. Optimism, pessimism, and gambling: the downside of optimism.
Personality and Social Psychology Bulletin, Vol. 30, No. 2, pp. 149-160.
Global Betting and Gaming Consultants 2010. Global gaming report (5th ed.). Author: Gainsbury, S. Castletown,
Isle of Man, British Isles.
Grifiths, M. 1995. Adolescent Gambling. Routledge, London, UK.
Griffiths, M. 2009. Internet gambling in the workplace. Journal of Workplace Learning, Vol. 21, No. 8, pp. 658-
670.
Hair, J., Black, W., Babin, B., Anderson, R. and Tatham, R. 2006. Multivariate Data Analysis. Pearson Prentice
Hall, New Jersey, USA.
Hershey, D. A. and Mowen, J. C. 2000. Psychological determinants of financial preparedness for retirement. The
Gerontologist, Vol. 40, No. 6, pp. 687-697.
Hirunyawipada, T. and Paswan, K. A. 2006. Consumer innovativeness and perceived risk: implications for high
technology product adoption. Journal of Consumer Marketing, Vol. 23, No. 4, pp. 182-198.
Holliday, S. (2011). The balance of power in global eGaming. EGR Live, Business Design Centre, London, UK.
Retrieved June 10th, 2011, from
http://www.h2gc.com/news.php?article=H2±Gambling±Capital±Presentations±-±EGR±Live±May±201.
Hawkins, D. and Mothersbaugh, D. 2009. Consumer behavior building marketing strategy. McGraw-Hill, New
York, USA.
Kelleher, G. 2010. The interactive gambling industry: Key trends 2010. Paper presented at the iGaming
Supershow, May 25-28 Prague, Czech Republic.
Lam, D. 2007. An Exploratory Study of Gambling Motivations and Their Impact on the Purchase Frequencies of
Various Gambling Products. Psychology and Marketing, Vol. 24, No. 9, pp. 815-827.
Lanjananda, P. and Patterson, G. P. 2009. Determinants of customer-oriented behavior in a health care context.
Journal of Service Management, Vol. 20, No. 1, pp. 5-32.
Licata, J. W., Mowen, J. C., Brown, T. and Donovan, T. (2003). On the trait antecedents and outcomes of service
worker job resourcefulness: a hierarchical model approach. Journal of the Academy of Marketing Sciences,
Vol. 31, No. 3, pp. 256-271.
McCloskey, D. W. 2006. The importance of ease of use, usefulness, and trust to online consumers: an examination
of the technology acceptance model with older consumers. Journal of Organizational and End User
Computing, Vol. 18, No. 4, pp. 47-65.
Mooradian, T., Renzl, B. and Matzler, K. 2006. Who trust? Personality, trust and knowledge sharing. Management
Learning, Vol. 37, No. 4, pp. 523-540.
Mowen, J. C. 2000. The 3M model of Motivation and Personality. Kluwer Academic Press, Boston, MA.
Mowen, J. C. 2004. Exploring the trait of competitiveness and its consumer behavior consequences. Journal of
Consumer Psychology, Vol. 14, No. 1-2, pp. 52-63.
Mowen, J. C., Park, S. and Zablah, A. 2007. Toward a theory of motivation and personality with application to
word-of-mouth communications. Journal of Business Research, Vol. 60, pp. 590-596.
Neighbors, C., Lostutter, T. W., Cronce, J. M. and Larimer, M.E. 2002. Exploring college student gambling
motivation. Journal of Gambling Studies, Vol. 18, No. 4, pp. 361-369.
Parke, A., Griffiths, M. and Irwing, P. 2004. Personality traits in pathological gambling: sensation seeking,
deferment of gratification and competitiveness as risk Factors. Addiction Research and Theory, Vol. 12, No. 3,
pp. 201-212.
Phillips, J., Tandoh, M., Noble, S. and Bush, V. (2004). The Value of Relationship Strength in Segmenting Casino
Patrons. Journal of Interactive Advertising, Vo. 5, No. 1, pp. 60-73.
PricewaterhouseCoopers 2011. Global gaming outlook. Retrieved December 5th, 2011, from
http://www.pwc.com/en_GX/gx/entertainment-media/publications/global-gaming-outlook.jhtml.
-147-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Rao, S., Truong, D., Senecal, S. and Le, T. 2007. How buyers’ expected benefits, perceived risks, and e-business
readiness influence their e-marketplaces usage. Industrial Marketing Management, Vol. 36, pp. 1035-1045.
Rogers, P. 1998. The Cognitive Psychology of Lottery Gambling: A Theoretical Review. Journal of Gambling
Studies, Vol. 14, No. 2, pp. 111-134.
Rundle-Thiele, S. and Bennett R. 2001. A brand for all seasons? A discussion of brand loyalty approaches and
their applicability for different markets. Journal of Product & Brand Management, Vol. 10, No. 1, pp. 25-37.
Sapnas, K. G. and Zeller, R. A. 2002. Minimizing sample size when using exploratory factor analysis for
measurement. Journal of Nursing Measurement, Vol. 10, pp. 135–154.
Walker, M. 1992. The Psychology of Gambling, Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK.
Wei, T., Marthandan, G., Chong, A., Ooi, K. and Arumugam, S. 2009. What drives Malaysian m-commerce
adoption? An empirical analysis. Industrial Management & Data Systems, Vol. 109, No. 3, pp. 370-388.
Wood, T. R. and Williams, J. R. 2011. A comparative profile of the Internet gambler: Demographic characteristics,
game-play patterns, and problem gambling status. New Media Society, Vol. 13, No. 7, pp. 1123-1141.
-148-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Western enterprises tend to be accustomed to work in a business environment which is comparable from their
respective domestic markets. These are usually characterized by a consolidated democracy, an efficient application
of the rule of law and a well-established free market framework. The expansion in search of new opportunities
sometimes entails the need to establish themselves in transformation markets. When working in such an
environment, companies may be confronted with uncertainties related to informal institutions and rules existing in
the new country of destiny.
Drawing on evidence gained through interviews, this study is to examine the impact of informal institutions such
as political corruption, favoritism and legal uncertainty on the business environment in Russia. In addition to that,
coping strategies adopted by Western enterprises are to be analyzed. This paper will focus on the third term of
President V. Putin.
Results indicate that corruption is a common risk for an overwhelming majority of Austrian companies regardless
of their size and sector they are working in. The incidences of two abovementioned remaining risks are of minor
importance and depending on these two factors. This paper shows how enterprises are dealing with these
challenges.
This study has been written for two model readers: an entrepreneur may use its findings for the improvement of the
understanding of business conditions on the spot. Anybody from academia, be it e.g. an economist or political
scientist, may study this paper in order to get a useful foundation for further in-depth research both on the political
risks and individual factors.
KEYWORDS
Business Environment, Coping Strategies, International Business, Political Risks, Russian Federation.
The aim lies in answering the following research questions: In which ways is Russian business
environment characterized by the neopatrimonial practices and how do Western enterprises react on
such system? The second question mainly looks at coping strategies to adjust to the specific Russian
market conditions.
Firstly I will discuss research and methodology. The second part consists of a more detailed case
analysis of the consequences of on political risks on Austrian firms in Russia. The final part will
outline coping strategies adopted by these companies to deal with the business environment they
operate in. At the end of the paper, the main conclusions are to be provided.
2. LITERATURE REVIEW
There are a few relatively recent publications, which pay attention to the interrelationship between
political and economic spheres in Russia using a neopatrimonial prism (cf. Bach 2013; Burkhard 2013;
Ledeneva 2013a; Robinson 2011, 2013) The concept of patrimonial capitalism applied by Robinson
can be seen as a variant of Weber’s patrimonialism and neo-patrimonialism in the economic sphere
(Robinson, 2011: 4). D. Bach has analyzed the state capture under a neopatrimonialist system in
various world regions, including Russia, Ukraine and Uzbekistan (Bach 2011). F. Burkhard provided
us with a study about the informal behavior of German companies in their interactions with
neopatrimonial system in Russia (Burkhard 2013). A. Ledeneva analyzed the nature, norms and
methods of informal governance under Putin drawing on this concept (Ledeneva 2013a: 1136). All
these studies have been very important for the practical shaping of this paper.
The renowned Ukrainian scholar O. Fisun was the first to classify specific forms of
neopatrimonialism in the post-Soviet space (Fisun 2012). According to him we have to distinguish
between three types of neopatrimonialism in this part of the world: “bureaucratic neopatrimonialism”,
“oligarchic neopatrimonialism”, and “sultanistic neopatrimonialism” (Fisun 2003: 6). Russia under
Putin/Medvedev was seen as “bureaucratic neopatrimonialism”. This subtype is characterised by the
“state bureaucratic monopolisation and semi-coercive decentralisation of neopatrimonial domination,
operating via secret police structures” (Fisun 2003: 6).
If we take a broader look on the relevant literature relating to the interplay between politics
and economics in Russia without direct reference to the neopatrimonial concept we may observe
different lines of research. The first line focuses on the role of informal institutions in the political and
administrative sphere. The role of informal relations in politics and red tape used to be in the focus of
Russian and Western scholars (see Ledeneva, 1998, 2006, 2013; Gel’man 2004).
As informal practices are much more difficult to describe by their illegal and consequently
secretive nature, we may not wonder that there are very few works on them especially in the branch of
bureaucracy responsible for the enforcement of the law. Solomon (2010) nevertheless took the burden
to analyze the formal and informal realities and the power of informal practices in the judicial system
in Russia.
Another line of research has elaborated on the role and structure of networks in political and economic
spheres. Krystanovskaya and White (2013) have analyzed the networks within the ruling elite and state
networks (Krystanovskaya and White, 2013), Ledeneva the informal practices within public
administration (Ledeneva 2013) and Hanson networks in domestic business state relations (Hanson
2013). Some scholars sought to define the dominating players in the state-business interactions and
showed a change in this relationship from state capture to business capture (c.f. Frye 2002; Yakovlev
and Zhuravskaya 2004; Yakovlev 2006).
A lot of interest has been paid on one particular informal institution: corruption. This instrument is
widely discussed as a practice present in the bureaucracy and the political system (Anderson 2012;
Hanson 2013; Holmes 2012; Nisnevich 2013; Yakovlev 2014). Business corruption constitute a theme
of many very interesting analyses (c.f. for instance Ledeneva 2011; Mommsen 2012).
The market for informal mediation between state and business in Russia has not yet received much
attention by academia. There are only a few studies on bureaucratic mediation (see Olimpieva 2008,
2010; Polishuk 2003, 2004).
There are only a few studies showing the empirical evidence of private business coping with particular
informal institutions, especially corruption. Kouznetsov and Dass have conducted a qualitative field
research on the areas of corruption among Russian distributors of foreign goods (Kouznetsov and Dass
2010). Another aspect was in the focus of Karhunen and Kosonen who have designed strategic
responses to corruption of foreign companies describing the behavior of Finish firms (Karhunen and
Kosonen 2013).
-150-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
There are also a few quantitative studies on informal practices related to corruption used by domestic
and foreign business in Russia (c.f. Denisova-Schmidt 2014, Ledeneva 2006; Shekshnia 2014). These
researchers have analyzed the business sector in general without clearly distinguishing between
domestic and foreign companies.
There is only one piece analyzing publicly accessible quantitative data on institutional barriers to entry
and exit business in Russia (Aidis and Adachi 2007). The impact of a set of informal institutions on
foreign business has not yet been addressed. This article attempts to close this gap.
where “laws and regulations are more or less systematically abused by the rulers, side-stepped, ignored,
or even tailored to fit their interests“ (Amundsen 1999: 3).
4. METHODOLOGY
This paper presents the findings of a field study conducted by the author between March and
September 2015 in Austria and Russia. The decision for using a qualitative approach was justified by
the sensitive character of the research problem. It helped me to investigate “how” of managerial
behavior in organizations. Based on an extensive literature review we designed a questionnaire and
consequently a category system. The interviews were conducted following the virtue of guidelines for
which purpose a questionnaire was designed. Expert interviews were selected as date collection
method. One to one interviews conducted in a confidential manner proved to be the appropriate tool to
provide access to information that would not have been accessible otherwise.
The collected data result from 24 qualitative interviews conducted with managers of Austrian
companies about their operations in Russia. Furthermore, I have had discussions with Russian experts
from academia, journalism and NGOs about the general business environment. The interview partners
from the business sphere represented a wide range of sectors and companies from SMEs to large
enterprises.
The Interviews were conducted by me in a language of choice of the interlocutor: English, German or
Russian. The 20 face to face personal interviews were supplemented by four interviews via phone or
Skype. All 24 conversations were taped with the consent of the participants. On average, the duration
of an interview was no less than one hour. Due to the confidentiality I have codified the firms as
numbers.
After the data collection, I have transcribed the entire interviews in the original languages. The
category system provided me guidance through the analysis of the interview material. In this respect I
followed Mayring’s (2000) content analysis while applying the deductive approach. The reason to opt
for the deductive approach was that a plethora of literature, providing rich variables and concepts, can
be found. This provided me with a solid basis for my research.
-152-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
contract and the type of service. The average rate of bribery is estimated at 30-40 percent of a
transaction (interview 9 and interview 11). In extreme cases like the IT sector it approaches 90 percent
(interview 9).
The official combat against this phenomenon makes the basis corruption more difficult. The traditional
practice of being bribed via money in an envelope is not possible any more (interview 9, interview 15
and interview 17). Supervision of corruption acts has become stricter, but the companies have learnt to
adopt and invent new instruments which are still not formally banned by law (interview 9, interview
13).
The frequency of such acts depends on the size of a project and business sector. A foreign company can
encounter such a demand when awarding a state contract or a contract with or companies close to the
government. In Russia the chance of solicitation of bribes is bigger when the involved company is large
one and/or when it is applying for a federal state project (interview 6, interview 15).
Companies have experienced demands in state procurement (interview 4, interview 9) and when
dealing with public tenders (interview 15, interview 19, interview 21, interview 23 and interview 24).
Any kind of illegal procurement of tenders is still present in infrastructure projects, especially in cases
of state sponsored projects (interview 15). It is also used in branches working with projects (interview
19). Obtaining an official document such as a certificate, permission or license is also usually
connected with corruption (interview 5, interview 13, interview 19 and interview 21).
It is difficult to trace corruption at customs because there is a common practice to outsource this kind
of services. Some companies point at situations where customs officers delayed the clearance process
arbitrarily in order to have it sped up with an extra payment (interview 13, interview 19, interview 20).
There is no problem with meeting the compliance standards in getting official gifts. In Russia, there is a
tradition that officials can receive gifts at the occasion of a national holiday. Companies have only to
stick to the allowed limits (interview 21). A Western company may escape corruption demands if it
offers an innovative product or service which is connected with know-how or a high-tech commodity
(interview 6, interview 7 and interview 16).
In the Russian market some formal institutions are sometimes used for informal ends. A system of
intermediaries which cooperate with bureaucracy has been established. They cover supportive issues
such as issuance of certificate or drawing up a plan. Officials are frequently affiliated with such an
office by family or friends (interview 5, interview 9, interview 17). It may happen that such a service
turns out to be “compulsory” in order to be awarded with the contract. The official will reject your
application if you do not follow their recommendations. The charges are obviously higher there but
there does not seem to be an alternative (interview 9).
Also legal offices can serve as mediators. If a company or public official is interested in that, a package
of the shares of a Western company may be transferred by virtue of such an office (interview 17).
bribery in order to have the illegal sentence imposed. The illegal sentence is used to compensate the
money to the law enforcement agencies for taking the companies over physically or use some sort of
goods raiders (interview 4).
A second option is to find a niche where foreign products are sought-after and local competition is low
or they offer a high-tech product which cannot be provided by domestic companies.
Another kind of corruption avoidance is to obtain the control of any sensitive area of the own company
like finances or accounting to external specialized companies. These companies report directly to their
headquarters in Europe and thus give only the outer control on the regional manager.
A more pragmatic strategy may be to outsource corruption. This entails the shift of responsibility for
some business operations such as sales and distribution to the Russian partner or the cooperation with
independent local companies in these areas.
In sectors where state permissions, licenses or certificates are obligatory, a company can use a mediator
to solve any related problem. A specialized company may then become responsible for getting the
needed certificate for them.
It seems to be a common practice to outsource customs services. The role of the broker is usually
played by a Russian company. In order to avoiding potential problems with Russian customs services,
Western business invented a system where tracks pass always the same state border and work with the
same broker on a permanent basis.
if problems are looming, Western business can always use the respective national embassies or
chambers of commerce in the host country as another instrument. The Austrian embassy and the
Chamber of Commerce are always ready to intervene for Austrian enterprises in the area of the
legislation or licensing. A company having a special problem may handle it unilaterally with the
support of national embassy of the economic chamber. The intervention on EU level is only an option
if a common problem appears for a group of EU countries.
In the case of a small contract with a Russian firm it is better to make Russia as a place of jurisdiction.
And it is also cheaper to do it in Russia than in one of the European Arbitrary Courts. If you have a
more complicated deal, especially if stakes are high, it would be better to regulate it under non-Russian
law.
6. CONCLUSION
When it comes to informal institutions there seems to be clear evidence that corruption, political
favoritism and legal uncertainly are a part of business activities of Western companies. The interviews
show that these factors differentiate in the impact on foreign business.
The results of this study show that corruption is a problem for almost every company regardless of the
size or line of business. There is only a slight deviation in the high-tech sector. The involvement in
local networks tends to be generally low. The contact with the judiciary is in general very sporadic.
Thus, while corruption affects all the size of a company as almost all sectors, political favoritism and
legal uncertainty are perceived as playing only a minor role in conduct of business. Corruption is the
dominant informal institution and we can find certain methods and some scale of the problem. Looking
at the results we may come to the conclusion that business should be able to survive without any access
to local political-economic networks and/or within the current state of judiciary. The question whether
these three informal institutions constitute political risks can neither be answered by “yes” or “no”.
Results of this research attempt to shed a light on some aspects and could serve as a starting point for
further research. Several themes may emerge from these findings and consequently require additional
work. Further exploration could provide important insight into the accessibility of local networks,
corruption schemes in particular sectors or use of legal intermediaries in problem solving process.
Furthermore, practitioners interested in entering the Russian market could also benefit from these
findings. They could easier develop entry strategies and be warned of the role of informal institutions.
REFERENCES
Agarwal J. and Feils D., 2007. Political risk and the internationalization of firms: an empirical study of Canadian-
based export and FDI firms. Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences 24:165–181.
Amundsen, I., 1999. Political Corruption: An Introduction to the Issues,
http://www.cmi.no/publications/file/1040-political-corruption.pdf, accessed 14 April 2015.
Anderson L., 2012. Corruption in Russia: Past, Present, Future. In Funderburk C. (ed.), Political Corruption in
Comparative Perspective. Sources, Status, Prospects, Ashgabe 2012, pp. 71-94
-155-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Bratton, M and Van de Walle, N., 1997. Democratic Experiments in Africa. Regime Transitions in Comparative
Perspective. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Erdmann, G., 2012a. Neopatrimonialism: concept or metaphor?, in: Heinrich, Andreas / Pleines, Heiko (eds.)
(2012): Challenges of the Caspian Resource Boom. Domestic elites and policy-making, Palgrave Macmilan, pp.
46-57.
Erdmann, G., 2012b. Neopatrimonialism: Problems of a Catch-all Concept?, in: Stewart, S. / Klein, M. / Schmitz,
A. / Schröder, H-H. (eds) (2012): Presidents, Oligarchs and Bureaucrats. Forms of Rule in the Post-Soviet Space,
Ashgate, pp. 43-62.
Erdmann, G. and Engel, U., 2007. Neopatrimonialism Revisited: Critical Review and Elaboration of an Elusive
Concept, in: Journal of Commonwealth and Comparative Studies, 45, 1, pp. 95-119
Fisun 0., 2012. Rethinking Post-Soviet Politics from a Neopatrimonial Perspective. Demokratizatsiya, “The
Journal of Post-Soviet Democratization”, 2012, vol. 20, nr. 2, pp.92-101.
Frye, T. 2002. Capture or Exchange? Business Lobbying in Russia. Europe-Asia Studies 54:8, pp.1017-36.
Gel’man V. (2004). The Unrule of Law in the Making: The Politics of Informal Institution-Building in Russia.
Europe-Asia Studies, 2004, vol.56, No 7, pp. 1021-1040.
Klein S. et al., 2012. Presidents, Oligarchs, and Bureaucrats. Forms of Rule in the Post-Soviet Space, Ashgate, pp.
187-202.
Hanson, P., 2011. Networks, Cronies and Business Plans: Business-State Relations in Russia, in: Kononenko, V. /
Moshes, A. (2011): Russia as a Network State. What Works in Russia When State Institutions Do Not?, Palgrave
Macmillan: Basingstoke, pp. 113-138.
Helmke G., Levitsky S., 2004. Informal Institutions and Comparative Politics: A Research Agenda, Perspectives
on Politics, Vol. 2, No. 4 pp. 725-740
Heinemann-Grüder, A., 2012. Patron-client Relations: Explanations and Conceptual Promises, in: Heinrich,
Andreas / Pleines, H. (eds.) (2012): Challenges of the Caspian Resource Boom. Domestic elites and policy-
making, Palgrave Macmilan, 58-72.
Eistenstadt, S.,1973. Traditional Patrimonialism and Modern Neopatrominialism. London, Beverly Hills: Sage
Publications
Leslie H., 2012. Corruption in Post-Soviet Russia, Global Change, Peace & Security: formerly Pacifica Review:
Peace, Security & Global Change, 24:2, pp. 235-250.
Krystanovskaya, O. and White, S. (2013), The Formation of Russia´s Network Directorate. In Kononenko, V. and
Moshes (eds.) (2011): Russia as a Network State, What Works in Russia When State Institutions Do Not?,
Palgrave Macmillan, pp. 19-39.
Kouznetsov A. and Mohan D., 2010. Areas of Corruption in the Distribution of Foreign-Made Goods Where a
Firm's Size and Origin Play a Role: The Russian Experience, Journal of East-West Business, 16:1, pp. 24-44.
Ledeneva, A., 2006. How Russia Really Works: The Informal Practices that Shaped Post-Soviet Politics and
Business. Ithaca: Cornell University Press
Ledeneva, A., 2011. Can Medvedev Change Sistema? Informal Networks and Public Administration in Russia. In
Kononenko M., Moshes A. (ed.) Russia as a Network State, What Works in Russia When State Institutions Do
Not? Palgrave Macmillan, pp. 19-38.
Ledeneva, A., 2013. Can Russia Modernize? Sistema, Power Networks and Informal Gouvenance, Cambridge
University Press.
Ledeneva, A., 2013a. Russian´s Practical Norms and Informal Governance: The Origin of Endemic Corruption. In
Social Research, Vo. 80: No. 4 Winter 2013, pp. 1135- 1162
Mommsen, M., 2012. Russia’s Political Regime: Neo-Soviet Authoritarianism and Patronal Presidentialism. In
Stewart, Susan / Klein, Margarete / Schmitz, Andrea / Schröder, H-H. (2012): Presidents, Oligarchs and
Bureaucrats. Forms of Rule in the Post-Soviet Space, pp. 63-88.
Nawaz, F., 2008. Corruption and resource distribution in neopatrimonial systems,
http://www.u4.no/publications/corruption-and-resource-distribution-in-neopatrimonial-systems/, Anti-Corruption
Resource Center, Bergen, accessed 14 April 2015.
Neil R., 2011. Russian Patrimonial Capitalism and the International Financial Crisis, Journal of Communist
Studies and Transition Politics, pp- 27:3-4,
Nisnevich Y., 2013. A., Political corruption in post-communist Russia / Working papers by NRU Higher School
of Economics. Series WP14 "Политическая теория и политический анализ". 2013. No. 08.
-156-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
O’Neil T., 2007. Neopatrimonialism and public sector performance and reform.
www.odi.org.uk/resources/docs/4393.pdf, accessed 12 April 2015.
Olimpieva, I. 2010. The Changing Contours of Corruption in Russia: Informal Intermediaries in State- Business
Relations, EAST-WEST Journal of Economics and Business, Vol. XIIΙ –No 2, pp. 61-82.
Olimpieva, I. and Pachenkov, O., 2008. Who fights corruption in Russia. In Robert, Orttung and Anthony, Latta
(Eds), Russia’s Battle with Crime, Corruption, and Terrorism, London: Routledge: 121-144.
Olimpieva, I., 2007. Fonovaya korruptsiya v sfere malogo I srednego biznesa:“oruzhie slabykh”? (Routine
corruption in the sphere of small and medium business: “weapons of the weak”?), In Olimpieva, I. and Pachenkov,
О. (ed.) Borba s vetryanymi melnitsami? Sotsialno-antropologicheskij podkhod kissledovaniyu korruptsii. SPb:
Aleteja, pp. 213-230.
Polishchuk, L.,2004. Korruptsiya i posrednicheskie firmy, Transition, 2.
Robinson N., 2013. Economic and political hybridity: Patrimonial capitalism in the post-Soviet sphere. In Journal
of Eurasian Studies 4 (2013): 136-145.
Robinson N., 2011. Russian Patrimonial Capitalism and the International Financial Crisis. Journal of
Communist Studies and Transition Politics, 27(3-4), s. 434-455.
Schlumberger, O., 2008. Structural reform, economic order, and development: patrimonial capitalism. Review of
International Political Economy, Vol. 15, No. 4, 622-649.
Shekshnia S.et at., 2014. How to Mitigate Corruption in Emerging Markets: The Case of Russia, Edmond J. Safra
Working Papers, No. 36
von Soest, Ch. et al, 2011. How Neopatrimonialism Affects Tax Administration: A Comparative Study of Three
World Regions. http://www.giga-hamburg.de/de/publikationen/working-papers Accessed 13 April 2015
Yakovlev, A., 2006. The Evolution of Business-State Interaction in Russia: From State Capture to Business
Capture? Europe-Asia Studies 58, pp. 1033-1056.
Yakovlev, A., 2004. Evolution of Corporate Governance in Russia: Governmental Policy vs. Real Incentives of
Economic Agents Post-Communist Economies 16:4, pp. 387-403.
Yakovlev, E. and Zhuravskaya E., 2004. State Capture: From Yeltsin to Putin. Manuscript. Moscow
ANNEX
Interviews:
Interview 1, am 25.03.2014
Interview 2, am 25.03.2014
Interview 3, am 25.03.2014
Interview 4, am 26.03.2014
Interview 5, am 26.03.2014
Interview 6, am. 27.03.2014
Interview 7, am. 27.03.2014
Interview 8, am 28.03.2014
Interview 9, am 28.03.2014
Interview 10, am 31.03.2014
Interview 11, am 01.04.2014
Interview 12, am 01.04.2014
Interview 13, am 01.04.2014
Interview 14, am 02.04.2014
Interview 15, am 02.04.2014
Interview 16, am 02.04.2014
Interview 17, am 03.04.2014
Interview 18, am 03.04.2014
-157-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
-158-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
ABSTRACT
Lithuania has unique characteristics and smart human resources which should be used to foster competitiveness.
This could be achieved only with an agreement on clear and achievable goal to fund human resources and
Research and Innovation (R&I) which would cater the needs of knowledge-based development. Smart
specialization has become a key element of the strategy Europe 2020, which refers to the guidelines for the next
decade in the development of regional innovation systems, also consolidates a "smart-growth principles", "green
growth" and "inclusion increase" in the EU's Cohesion Policy. Smart specialization is a strategic approach to
priority education together with culture and religion is a key for sustainable growth and development in the
society. The aim of this paper is to achieve two objectives. Firstly, to analyze statistics and to define the smart
specialization in the context of the personality creativity and innovation. Secondly, to analyze the main indicators
based on expert interviews about measuring the sustainability and foresight/intelligence of educational processes,
individual institutions, organizations and regions. Finally, to argue that education is a central indicator for
integration and universal sustainable development. This is encouraged by additional focus on simulations and
education based on creative design. It encloses indicators associated with the needs of local community,
meaningful and creative business of children, youth, women and elderly people.
KEYWORDS
7. INTRODUCTION
Smart Education is positive socialization strategy, which relies on positive psychology (Anthony D.
Ong and Manfred H. M. Van Dulmen, 2006) methodological provision and use of innovative
technologies of how social partnership approaches family, institutional, community, regional and
global levels. This investigation will select and reveal 12 smart education indicators reflecting smart
educational levels, enabling people to master and operate the 3d/3m (Kvieskiene G., Celiesiene e.,
2014) model with multifunctional, multicriterial, multisectoral approach.
Smart Education - is positive socialization strategy, which relies on positive psychology
methodological provision and use of innovative technologies of social partnership approaches family,
institutional, community, regional and global levels. The investigation will select and reveal 12
measurement indications and criteria of smart education (Kvieskiene G., Celiesiene E., 2014) reflecting
intelligent educational levels, enabling young people to master and operate the 3D model
(multifunction, multicriteria, multi-sectoral) approach.
Positive socialization we understand how smart educational tool that through a systematic
institutional, political, technological, social and regional systematic approach in order to discover the
criteria to ensure the public interest in shaping the socio-economic policies and decision-making. Over
the past decades, youth empowerment models and strategy becomes increasingly important not only in
research but also in the global development organizations studies. The youth policy-oriented research,
social networks and international organizations initiative enables young people to participate more in
-159-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
the national and global level decision-making. A systematic analysis of implied and synthesis, which
will create new of smart education of youth empowerment is based on the theory underlying the
adequate formation of young people competences portfolio of options and measurement criteria. Smart
and sustainable education and its sustainability, as well as the quality of education are widely discussed
and controversially perceived in theoretical literature.
Smart Education as a central indicator of integration and growth is encouraged by additional focus
on simulation and education based on creative design. Happy and creative personality is the most
important starting point for positive socialization and sustainable education system. Smart Education in
the practice and theoretical research analyzes pecularities through quality services, public arena,
tradition, fashion, software, tourism, leisure industry and connects it with creativity and social safety.
This phenomenon is directly related to Creative Economy and Social Capital, which is rapidly
increasing through the creation of new jobs, creating new market requirements in response to market
expectations. The creative economy and social capital is based on ideas rather than on physical capital,
it includes social industries and social communication technologies. The new information, digital
content technologies, startups opens up new spaces and reduces costs. The second feature – increasing
interactivity which bounds together creative view of the creator and the consumer. For managing this
new phenomenon, we analyze smart positive socialization scenarios. We understand positive
socialization (Kvieskiene G., 2005) as a smart educational tool, that through systematic institutional,
political, technological, social, ecological and regional approach discovers the criteria to ensure the
public interest in shaping the socio-economic policies and decision-making. Over the past decades,
citizen empowerment models and strategy becomes increasingly important not only in research but also
in the global development studies. The research oriented to citizen enabling policy, social networks and
international organizations initiatives enables people to participate more in decision making on the
national and global levels. A systematic analysis of preferences education and synthesis, will create
new forms of smart education and of citizen empowerment is based on the theory underlying the
adequate formation of people competencies portfolio of options and measurement criteria. Smart and
sustainable education and its sustainability, as well as the quality of education, are widely discussed
and controversially perceived in theoretical publications.
Smart Education as a central indicator of integration and growth is encouraged by additional focus
on simulation and education based on creative design. Happy and creative personality is the most
important starting point for positive socialization and sustainable education system. Creation of
economic impact is greatest in traditional creative industries, while adapting skills and business models
for the creation of organizations and the value and management of intellectual capital. Different
practices of how to separate processes, creativity and economy has evolved independently for many
centuries, but in the twenty-first century they acquired a new common denominator - they became a
creative economy, with intellectual property as a key element in this new economy character
(Levickaite, 2011). Today, organizations are becoming increasingly dependent on creativity, because of
the abandonment of the traditional physical raw materials and increasing use of the intangible,
intellectual raw materials. Creativity is considered highly important for innovation and economic
success (Asheim, B., 2006, Huggins, R., Izushi, H., Prokop, D., Thompson, P., 2014). Companies in
the creative industries, such as design, publishing, software or the arts, are normally seen as particularly
innovative (Lazzeretti, L., 2012, 6. Di Maria, E., Grandinetti, R., Di Bernardo, B., 2012). Cities and
communities are important for these relationships: creative industries tend to be urban industries, which
take advantage of shared knowledge and of a density of specialised customers, suppliers, and workers
to create new products (Asheim, B. T., Ebersberger, B., & Herstad, S., 2012). Businesses benefit both
from the diversity of urban environments, which may provide a range of stimuli, and from the
specialisation, allowed by the urban environments. Furthermore, recent research states that such
externalities will be related to city size: larger cities provide greater externalities, making firms in large
cities more innovative (Duranton and Puga, 2003; Stolarick and Florida, 2006).
For this paper, sustainability is defined broadly in order to include not only environmental concerns
but also economic and socioecological issues — the triple bottom line now being adopted in the
private, public, society and civic communities with creative approach. Sustainability defined as
creating and maintaining institutions, communities, economies, and societies that can coexist in
harmony with the natural world and with each other far into the future.
2.1. Community based industries for creative economy
-161-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
-162-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
-163-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Smart positive socialization as social innovation is based on the idea of the embodiment, based on
3D (multisectoral, multi-functional, multiple criteria) modeling in educational, cultural and religious
arenas to simulate sustainable development and social capital. In this way, the smart positive
socialization running (or) creating breakthrough trends and new opportunities to quickly and creatively
use knowledge, innovation, learning, networking and widest possible range of individual and public
(community) well-being, with rational costs now and in the future (3 Fig.).
questionnaires were sent for selected representatives. 165 questionnaires were received back: 49 from
representatives of civic society organizations, 101 from experts. The efficient use of changing
demographic situation, existing infrastructure and the management of resources reduction are important
priorities, it is proposed to foster local traditions, protect the natural and cultural heritage, avoid
disproportionate field investments. Survey participants believe that the greatest community challenges,
issues to be addressed are energy resources, territorial planning, demography and weak communities
(Celesiene E., Kvieskiene G., 2014).
Participants suggest these features of strong communities: • Community develops an important,
positive leadership;
• Decisions are made on a "bottom-up" approach;
• Businesses and community work together on the construction investment project from
conception to implementation;
• Local culture and traditions are fostered, the environment identity is built and protected;
• A system for dissemination of information is set up on community level which allows
members to provide timely feedback;
Good practices are openly shared between neighboring communities and the wider community
network in order to work for the sake of the city or town, not to compete.
3. CONCLUSION
Main components of sustainable education are the education policy, competitiveness and social
differentiation, integral sustainable educational prerequisites and smart positive socialization indexes,
which can be analyzed through the social, creative and socioecological approaches.
Previously understood almost as the exclusive preserve of the non-profit sector, social innovation
is now seen as a broader concept that is increasingly being applied in 3D model (multisectoral,
multifuncional and multifactoral), notably the public, private, for profit or NGO sectors, as well as the
scientific or socioecological approach.
This broadening of our understanding of the concept and expanding application to new
multifuncional design of Preference of Education for Universal Sustainable Development Context and
gives socioeducational innovation new impetus and energy.
New ways for organizations to work together, new forms of networking, and new possibilities to
work across sectors appear to be proliferating. New kinds of public/private/NGO social partnerships
create conditions for social innovation, where Small and Medium-sized Enterprises (SMEs), Social
Economy Organizations optimizes the costs and accumulates Social Capital. As such, the proposed
subject would be “Social Partnerships influenced by Innovative Solutions” with the objective to
analyze the Social Partnerships on Innovation and Social Capital development.
The existence of social mechanisms for transformability, such as those identified in this article, is
essential to move away from a less desired trajectory toward a socio-ecological approach with the
capacity to manage ecosystems sustainably for human well-being. Adaptability will be needed to
strengthen and sustain such a desired state and make it resilient to future change and unpredictable
events.
REFERENCES
Huggins, R., Izushi, H., Prokop, D., Thompson, P., 2014. The Global Competitiveness of Regions. Routledge, 260
pages.
Duranton, G., Puga, D., 2003, Micro-Foundations of Urban Agglomeration Economies. National Bureau of
Economic Research, August 2003
Kvieskiene G., 2005. Positive socialization
Kvieskiene G., Kvieska V., 2012. Social partnership for innovation. 265 pages.
Kvieskiene G., Bardauskiene D., Community-based sustainable development.
Lazzeretti, L., 2012. Creative Industries and Innovation in Europe: Concepts, Measures and Comparative Case
Studies. Routledge, - 328 pages
Oxford Handbook of Methods in Positive Psychology, 2006. Edited by Anthony D. Ong and Manfred H. M. Van
Dulmen. 02 November 2006. 672 Pages | 87 line illus.7 x 10 inches
-165-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
Di Maria, et al., 2012. Exploring Knowledge-Intensive Business Services: Knowledge Management Strategies. 277
pages.
Jahn, T., et al., 2009. Understanding Social-Ecological Systems: Frontier Research for Sustainable Development.
Implications for European Research Policy. Institute for Social-Ecological Research (ISOE), Frankfurt/Main,
Germany.
Foray, D., et al., 2009. Smart specialization: the concept, Ch .3 in Knowledge for Growth: Prospects for science,
technology and innovation, Report, EUR 24047, European Union. Also Available as K4G Policy Brief No. 9,
EC (DG-Research)
Levickaite R., 2011. Creative industries: classification systems and models for the twenty-first century. The
creative economy. Science - Future of Lithuania, 3 (4), 21-27 pages.
Stolarick K., Florida R., (2006), Creativity, connections and innovation: a study of linkages in the Montréal
Region, Environment and Planning A 38(10) 1799 – 1817.
Aslesen, H.W., Onsager, K., 2008. Knowledge bases, open innovations and city regions. Summer Conference,
2009. Denmark, Copenhagen.
Asheim, B., 2006. (edt.), Constructing Regional Advantage: Principles – Perspectives – Policies. Report pf DG
Research Expert Group on ‘Constructing Regional Advantage’. European Commission, Brussel.
Asheim, B., et al., 2012. MNCs between the global and the local: Knowledge bases, proximity and globally
distributed knowledge networks. In M. Heidenreich (Ed.), Innovation and Institutional Embeddedness of
Multinational Companies. Cheltenham: Edward Elgar.
Bardauskiene Dalia, 2014. Sustainable communities – sustainable development. Sustainable Development
Academy, May 2014.
Celiesiene, E.; Kvieskiene, G., 2014. The development of indicators for sustainable education, The 8th
international scientific conference "Business and Management 2014": selected papers. May 15-16, 2014.
Vilnius: Technika, 858–866
Children's well-being in Rich Countries: A Comparative Review. LT: 27 from 29 countries. Previewed in 2014,
August 24.
Conference of the parties to the convention on biological diversity, 1998. Fourth meeting. Bratislava, Slovakia
Creative Economic: Report for 2010, United Nations Conference on Trade and Development, February 2011.
Introducing the first report on the Creative Economy of California, 2014. Los Angeles County Economic
Development Corporation, February 2014.
Legatum prosperity index, 2015.
Neil Adams, Neil Harris, 2005. Best practice guidelines for regional development strategies, Cardiff University.
NLP Association, 2014. Social development of researcher competence development opportunities. Feasibility
study. 102 pages.
The Role of Education in Promoting the Social Economy in Canada, 2009. A publication of the Canadian Social
Economy Hub., October 2009.
UNESCO World Report 2: Investing in Cultural Diversity and Intercultural Dialogue, UNESCO Publishing. 2009
World Happiness Report LT. 71 from 156, 2013.
What is the ecosystem approach? Ecosystems Knowledge Network.
-166-
7th International Conference
EBEEC 2015 - “The Economies of Balkan and Eastern Europe Countries in the Changed World”
Eastern Macedonia and Thrace Institute of Technology – Department of Accounting and Finance (Greece),
University of Macedonia, Department of Balkan, Slavic and Oriental Studies (Greece)
INDEX
A G
Accounting .................................................... 64 Green products.............................................121
Agribusiness ................................................. 25
I
agriculture ................................................... 106
Auditor .......................................................... 86 institutions .....................................................54
International Business .................................149
B
Irrational behavioral ......................................10
banks ............................................................. 16
L
Black Sea Region .......................................... 35
Boundaryless mindset ................................... 75 Legal Systems ................................................35
Business Environment ................................ 149 legislation ......................................................81
C M
-167-